Back to GetFilings.com





UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

FORM 10-K


[X] ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES
EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2003

OR

[ ] TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES
EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 FOR THE TRANSITION PERIOD FROM TO

0-23494
(COMMISSION FILE NO.)
BRIGHTPOINT, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

DELAWARE 35-1778566
(State or other jurisdiction of (I.R.S. Employer
incorporation) Identification No.)

501 AIRTECH PARKWAY, PLAINFIELD, INDIANA 46168
(Address of principal executive offices including zip code)

REGISTRANT'S TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE: (317) 707-2355

SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OF THE ACT: NONE

SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(g) OF THE ACT:
COMMON STOCK, $.01 PAR VALUE
PREFERRED SHARE PURCHASE RIGHTS


Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required
to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during
the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was
required to file such reports) and (2) has been subject to such filing
requirements for the past 90 days. Yes [X] No [ ]

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405
of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the
best of registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements
incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this
Form 10-K. [ ]

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is an accelerated filer (as
defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes [X] No [ ]

The aggregate market value of the Registrant's Common Stock held by
non-affiliates as of June 30, 2003, which was the last business day of the
registrant's most recently completed second fiscal quarter was approximately
$96,742,866. As of March 1, 2004, there were 19,266,018 shares of the
registrant's Common Stock outstanding.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE: None






PART I

ITEM 1. BUSINESS.

GENERAL

Brightpoint, Inc. is one of the largest dedicated distributors of
wireless devices and accessories and providers of integrated logistics services
to network operators, with operations centers and/or sales offices in various
countries including Australia, Colombia, France, Germany, India, New Zealand,
Norway, the Philippines, Sweden and the United States. We provide integrated
logistics services including, procurement, inventory management, customized
packaging, fulfillment, activation management, prepaid and e-business solutions
within the global wireless industry. Our customers include wireless network
operators, resellers, retailers and wireless equipment manufacturers. We handle
wireless products manufactured by wireless device manufacturers such as Nokia,
Motorola, Kyocera, Audiovox, Sony Ericsson, Siemens, Samsung, Panasonic and
PalmOne.

We were incorporated under the laws of the State of Indiana in August
1989 under the name Wholesale Cellular USA, Inc. and reincorporated under the
laws of the State of Delaware in March 1994. In September 1995, we changed our
name to Brightpoint, Inc.

Our website is www.brightpoint.com. We make available free of charge at
this website our Code of Business Conduct, annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly
reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those
reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934 ("Exchange Act"), as soon as reasonably practicable after
we electronically file such material with, or furnish it to, the United States
Securities and Exchange Commission. The information on the website listed above,
is not and should not be considered part of this annual report on Form 10-K and
is not incorporated by reference in this document.

In addition, we will provide, at no cost, paper or electronic copies of
our reports and other filings made with the United States Securities and
Exchange Commission. Requests should be directed to Investor Relations,
Brightpoint, Inc., 501 Airtech Parkway, Plainfield, Indiana 46168, telephone
number: (877) 477-2355.

Unless the context otherwise requires, the terms "Brightpoint",
"Company", "we", "our" and "us" means Brightpoint, Inc. and its consolidated
subsidiaries.

FINANCIAL OVERVIEW AND RECENT DEVELOPMENTS

Financial Overview. Wireless devices handled by the Company grew by 34%
to 20.3 million devices from 15.2 million devices in 2002. Revenue grew by 41%
to $1.8 billion in 2003 from $1.3 billion in 2002, which was driven by a 52%
growth rate of wireless devices sold through our distribution businesses.

Net income improved to $11.7 million, or $0.62 per diluted share, in
2003 from a net loss of $42 million, or $2.35 per diluted share, in 2002.
Included in the 2002 net loss was a $44 million gain on debt extinguishment
partially offset by $41 million charge related to a cumulative effect of a
change in accounting principle, net of tax, which did not recur in 2003.


1



Cash and cash equivalents (unrestricted) were $99 million at December
31, 2003, an increase of 126% from $44 million at December 31, 2002. The
increase in cash and cash equivalents (unrestricted) was primarily due to net
cash provided by operating activities of $56 million in 2003 and proceeds from
common stock issuances under employee stock option and purchase plans of $12.4
million in 2003 partially offset by capital expenditures of $6.1 million in
2003.

Extension of Nokia contract in the United States. In December 2003, the
Company's North America subsidiary entered into an agreement, which extended its
relationship with Nokia in the United States to January 1, 2006, subject to
earlier termination as provided under the agreement. The Company continues to be
the exclusive authorized distributor for Nokia brand wireless devices in the
United States. In instances, when Nokia does not sell directly to their large
accounts, Nokia utilizes the Company's supply chain expertise to market, sell
and deliver wireless devices to network operators, independent agents and
national retailers throughout the United States.

Entry into India. During the second quarter of 2003, we entered into
India to meet the needs of one of the fastest growing markets for wireless
devices in the world. This entry was a significant step in implementing our
overall growth strategy. We have established our headquarters in New Delhi,
recruited key members of the management team and other employees and entered
into a supply agreement with Nokia India Private Limited.

Consolidation of Richmond, California, facility. During 2003, the
Company consolidated its Richmond, California, call center operation into its
Plainfield, Indiana, facility to reduce costs and increase productivity and
profitability in its Americas division. During 2003, the Company recorded a
pre-tax charge of $5.5 million which includes approximately $3.8 million for the
present value of estimated lease costs, net of an anticipated sublease, non-cash
losses on the disposal of assets of approximately $1.1 million and severance and
other costs of approximately $600 thousand.

GLOBAL WIRELESS INDUSTRY

The global wireless industry's primary purpose is to provide mobile
voice and data connectivity to subscribers. To enable this capability for the
subscriber, the global wireless industry is generally organized as follows:

o Network operators: build and operate wireless networks and provide the
voice and data access services to subscribers.

o Infrastructure designers, manufacturers, builders, and operators:
companies who operate in this segment provide network operators with
technology, equipment, and cell sites to build and operate the
networks.

o Wireless device manufacturers: design, manufacture, and market the
wireless devices, such as cellular phones, wireless personal digital
assistants, and pagers, which connect subscribers to the wireless
network.

o Components designers and manufacturers: design technology and
components that are embedded within a wireless device. Components
include semiconductor chip sets, displays, and antennae, among others.


2


o Retail and distribution: retail provides subscribers and potential
subscribers with an access point, either physical or on-line, to
purchase a subscription and/or a wireless device; distribution provides
logistics and distribution services to physically move wireless devices
and related products from manufacturers or network operators to
subscribers.

There are no clear boundaries within the wireless industry and with
other industries. Many network operators operate their own retail and
distribution networks. Many electronics and mass retailers market wireless
products and services. Many freight logistics companies and information
technology distribution companies offer logistics and distribution services to
the global wireless industry.

Wireless voice and data services are available to consumers and
businesses over regional, national and multi-national networks through wireless
network operators who utilize digital and analog technological standards, such
as:



Generation Technology Standards
---------- --------------------

1G Analog AMPS
2G Digital TDMA, CDMA, GSM, iDEN
2.5G Digital GPRS, EDGE, CDMA 1xRTT
3G Digital W-CDMA/UMTS, CDMA 1xEV-DV


Developments within the global wireless industry have allowed wireless
subscribers to talk, send text messages, send and receive email, capture and
transmit digital images, send multimedia messages, play games and browse the
Internet using their wireless devices. Wireless devices and services are also
being used for monitoring services, point-of-sale transaction processing,
inter-device communications, local area networks, location monitoring, sales
force automation and customer relationship management.

From 2002 to 2003, the estimated number of worldwide wireless
subscribers increased by approximately 190 million, or 17%, to approximately 1.3
billion. From 2001 to 2002 the number of worldwide wireless subscribers
increased by approximately 205 million, or 22%. At the end of 2003, wireless
penetration was estimated to be approximately 21% of the world's population. The
number of worldwide subscribers is expected to grow to approximately 1.5 billion
subscribers by the end of 2004. During 2003, the global wireless industry saw
shipments of wireless devices increase from approximately 400 million in 2002 to
an estimated 471 million wireless devices in 2003. Wireless device shipments are
currently forecasted to be approximately 525 million devices in 2004. The
percentage of replacement wireless device shipments has grown and is forecasted
to be approximately 68% of total shipments in 2004. Additionally, the use of
wireless data products, including interactive pagers, personal digital
assistants and other mobile computing devices, has seen recent growth and wider
consumer acceptance. The industry data contained in this paragraph and elsewhere
in this subsection was obtained from a leading investment bank.

We believe the following major trends are taking place within the
global wireless industry, although there are no assurances that we will benefit
from these trends (see BUSINESS RISK FACTORS discussed below):

Replacement Devices. As overall subscriber penetration increases in
certain markets, growth in wireless device volume is dependent on the
replacement cycle, which is defined as the period of time


3


before a subscriber replaces their existing wireless device with a new one.
During 2003, the global wireless industry saw shipments of replacement wireless
devices increase from approximately 195 million devices to an estimated 281
million devices. In 2004, it is estimated that shipments of replacement devices
will total approximately 355 million and represent approximately 68% of total
wireless device shipments. We believe that the key drivers for the growth in
shipments of replacement devices will be new features and enhanced functionality
such as color displays, camera-enabled handsets, multimedia messaging services
(MMS), handsets and network services with Internet access, devices with
entertainment features such as audio and gaming, and switching of customers
across wireless network operators. In the United States, local number
portability - i.e., the ability of wireless subscribers to retain their wireless
phone numbers when switching network operators, may induce more customers to
switch networks. The act of switching networks is often accompanied by the
acquisition of a new wireless device. While the new features and enhanced
functionalities and the effects of local number portability in the U.S. are
anticipated to increase both replacement device shipments and total wireless
device shipments, general economic conditions, consumer acceptance, component
shortages, manufacturing difficulties, supply constraints and other factors
could negatively impact anticipated wireless device shipments.

Increasing Subscribers. We expect the number of subscribers worldwide
to continue to increase. Slow economic growth and a high percentage of
subscriber penetration in many markets have caused the rate of the increase in
these markets to slow in recent years. Renewed economic growth, increased
wireless service availability or lower cost of wireless service compared to
conventional wireline telephone systems and reductions in the cost of wireless
devices may accelerate the rate of subscriber growth. Increasing deregulation,
the availability of additional spectrum, increased competition and the emergence
of new wireless technologies and related applications may further increase the
number of subscribers in markets that have historically had high penetration
rates. More wireless network operators may offer services including seamless
roaming, increased coverage, improved signal quality and greater data handling
capabilities through increased bandwidth thus, attracting more subscribers to
wireless network operators which offer such services. In order to provide these
services and maintain competitive cost structures, wireless network operators
may place additional pressure on our prices and service levels.

Migration to Next Generation Systems. In order to provide a compelling
service offering for its current and prospective subscribers, wireless network
operators continue to expand and enhance their systems by migrating to next
generation systems such as 2.5G and 3G systems. This migration will enable
wireless network operators to provide subscribers with enhanced voice and data
services such as multimedia messaging services, wireless Internet access,
integrated music players, streaming video, location-based services, enterprise
applications and video gaming. In order to realize the full advantage of these
services and capabilities, subscribers will need to replace their wireless
devices. As a result, the continued migration to next generation systems is
expected to be a key driver for replacement sales of wireless devices. However,
the ability and timing of wireless network operators to rollout these new
services and manufacturers to provide devices which utilize these services may
have a significant effect on consumer adoption and the sale of replacement
devices.

New or Expanding Industry Participants. With the opportunities
presented by enhanced voice and data capabilities and an expanding market for
wireless devices, many companies are entering or


4


expanding their presence in the global wireless industry. Examples of recent
entrants to the global wireless industry include Microsoft (wireless device
operating systems) and High Tech Computer Corp. (wireless device original design
manufacturer). In addition, companies such as LG Electronics (wireless device
original equipment manufacturer), Panda Electronics (Chinese original equipment
manufacturer) and ZTE Corporation (Chinese original equipment manufacturer) are
expanding their presence in the global wireless industry. These companies and
their products may heighten competition with existing manufacturers and provide
consumers with more feature-rich products, lower handset prices, broader
selection and new market channels, which may result in increased wireless device
shipments.

Pricing Trends. It is estimated that the industry's average selling
price for wireless devices declines by approximately 10% to 15% per year. A
number of factors impact the actual average selling prices including, but not
limited to, consumer demand, product availability, fluctuations in currency
exchange rates, product mix and device functionality. While manufacturers have
been adding enhanced features such as color screens and embedded cameras, we
anticipate that the industry's average selling prices for wireless devices will
continue to decline. The anticipated decline in average selling prices could
offset the anticipated growth in overall wireless shipments and have an adverse
impact on both the industry's and the Company's revenues.

OUR BUSINESS

We are one of the largest dedicated distributors of wireless devices
and providers of integrated logistics services to wireless network operators,
resellers, retailers and wireless equipment manufacturers. We strive to be an
integral service provider to our customers and suppliers by meeting their supply
chain needs in the global wireless industry. We accomplish this through
authorized distribution of wireless voice and data products to help
manufacturers achieve their key business objectives including increasing unit
sales volume, market share and points of sale. Our integrated logistics services
are intended to provide outsourcing solutions for wireless network operators'
mission-critical requirements. These integrated logistics services are designed
to support wireless network operators with a variable cost model in their
efforts to add new subscribers and increase system usage while minimizing
wireless network operators' investments in distribution infrastructure.

Product Distribution. Our product distribution activities include the
purchasing, warehousing, marketing, selling, picking, packing, shipping and
delivery of a broad selection of wireless voice and data products from leading
manufacturers. Product distribution revenue includes the value of the product
sold and generates higher revenue per unit, as compared to our integrated
logistics services revenue, which does not include the value of the product. We
frequently review and evaluate wireless voice and data products in determining
the mix of products purchased for distribution and attempt to acquire
distribution rights for those products, which we believe have the potential for
enhanced financial return and significant market penetration. In 2003, 2002 and
2001, approximately 87%, 85% and 89%, respectively, of our total revenue was
derived from product distribution. In 2003, 2002 and 2001, our gross margin on
product distribution revenue was 3.5%, 2.7% and 3.5%, respectively. Cost of
revenue for product distribution includes the costs of the products sold,
warehousing, labor and other costs.

The wireless devices we distribute include a variety of devices
designed to work on various operating platforms and feature brand names such as
Nokia, Motorola, Kyocera, Audiovox, Sony


5


Ericsson, Siemens, Samsung, Panasonic and PalmOne. In 2003, 2002 and 2001, our
sales of wireless devices through product distribution totaled 10.8 million, 7.1
million, and 7.1 million units, respectively, and represented approximately 53%,
47% and 51%, respectively, of the total wireless devices we handled. In 2003,
2002 and 2001, our average selling prices for wireless devices were
approximately $137, $137, and $135 per unit, respectively.

We also distribute accessories used in connection with wireless
devices, such as batteries, chargers, cases and "hands-free" products. We
purchase and resell original equipment manufacturer (OEM) and aftermarket
accessories, either prepackaged or in bulk. Our accessory packaging services
provide wireless network operators and retail chains with custom packaged and/or
branded accessories based on the specific requirements of that customer.

Integrated Logistics Services. Our integrated logistics services
include, inventory management, product procurement, product fulfillment, kitting
and customized packaging, prepaid airtime distribution, activation management,
freight management, credit services and receivables management, reverse
logistics and end-user support services. Generally, integrated logistics
services are a fee-based service. In certain instances, integrated logistics
service revenue includes the distribution and value of prepaid wireless airtime.
In many of our markets, we have contracts with wireless network operators and
equipment manufacturers pursuant to which we currently provide our integrated
logistics services. These customers include, but are not limited to, operating
companies or subsidiaries of Nextel (United States), Virgin Mobile (United
States), ALLTEL (United States), COMCEL (Colombia), MetroPCS (United States),
SFR (France), Sprint PCS (United States), TracFone (United States), and Vodafone
(Australia).

During 2003, 2002 and 2001, integrated logistics services accounted for
approximately 13%, 15% and 11%, respectively, of our total revenue. In 2003,
2002 and 2001, integrated logistics services accounted for approximately 47%,
53% and 49%, respectively, of the total wireless devices we handled. Over the
last three years our logistics services gross margin has ranged from 20% to 25%.
Cost of revenue for integrated logistics services is primarily composed of
labor, warehousing, information technology and other costs. Additionally, since
we generally do not take ownership of the inventory in many of our integrated
logistics services arrangements, the invested capital requirements in providing
integrated logistics services are less than our distribution business.

OUR STRATEGY

Our strategy is to continue to grow as a global leader in wireless
product distribution and the provision of logistics services to network
operators and manufacturers. Our objectives are to increase the Company's
earnings, increase market share in existing geographic markets, maintain or
improve our return on invested capital within certain debt-to-total-capital
parameters and to enhance customer satisfaction by increasing the value we offer
relative to other service alternatives and service offerings by our competitors.

Our strategy incorporates industry trends such as increasing sales of
replacement devices, increasing subscribers, and the migration to next
generation systems as described in detail in the section entitled "GLOBAL
WIRELESS INDUSTRY." We will endeavor to grow the business contemplating these
current and anticipated trends. Key elements of our strategy include:


6


Expand Existing Product and Service Offerings in Current Markets. Our
plan includes the transfer of our industry know-how, relationships, and
capabilities from one market to another in an effort to expand our product and
service offerings within our current markets. This is intended to enhance the
service offerings and product lines of our operations, which have relatively
limited product lines and service offerings as compared to the collective
product and service offerings of the entire Company. Opportunities in expanding
our product lines include wireless handsets, data devices, and accessories.
Opportunities in expanding our service offerings include product fulfillment,
electronic prepaid recharge services, reverse logistics management, repair
services, and channel management services.

Add New Products and Services in Current Markets. With increasing
functionality of wireless devices due to technological advancements and
migration to next generation systems, we believe that device manufacturers may
introduce innovative products, which we may distribute. Our strategy includes
the search for new products and service offerings within the current geographic
markets in which we operate. Potential product categories include Wi-Fi,
wireless games and entertainment products, and memory cards.

Expand into New Geographic Markets. We estimate that the global
wireless industry shipped 471 million wireless devices in 2003. In the
geographic markets where we currently operate - i.e. our addressable market, we
estimate the market size was 131 million wireless devices in 2003. We currently
operate in the United States and Colombia within the Americas division;
Australia, India, the Philippines, New Zealand and export markets within the
Asia-Pacific division; and Sweden, France, Germany, and Norway within the Europe
division. We believe we are in a position to expand our addressable market by
entering into new markets. In 2003, we entered into the India market and plan on
expanding our presence in that market in 2004. We believe there may be
additional expansion opportunities in Asia. We believe that we may have
opportunities for expansion in Europe. Eastern European countries, which
currently have lower penetration rates than Western European countries and less
mature distribution infrastructure are experiencing relatively high growth rates
in the sale of wireless devices. We may also pursue expansion efforts in Western
Europe, where the market for wireless devices tend to have higher penetration
rates and where distribution infrastructure is more mature, if we believe that
the economics of these opportunities are consistent with our objectives. The
anticipated long-term rate of return, short-term return on invested capital and
the risk profile as compared to the potential return will be key components in
our decision-making process. We expect to have adequate liquidity to finance our
anticipated geographic expansion through cash, debt or issuance of equity. For
further discussion on liquidity, refer to "MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS."

Continue to Build and Promote the Brightpoint Brand within the Wireless
Industry. Many of our customers and suppliers operate in many markets globally.
We believe that strengthening our corporate brand and delivering a consistent
message globally may allow us to compete for business more effectively than
local unbranded distribution companies or logistics services providers who are
not solely dedicated to serving the global wireless industry. We have developed
distribution and logistics expertise that is unique to the global wireless
industry and, through branding, plan on leveraging that expertise to further
grow the business.


7


CUSTOMERS

We provide our products and services to a customer base of
approximately 23,000 wireless network operators, manufacturers, agents and
dealers, retailers, and other distributors. During 2003, customers in each of
our primary sales channels include the following:

Wireless Network Operators: Reliance Industries Limited (India), Dobson
Cellular (United States), Globe Telecom (Philippines), Nextel (United
States), Virgin Mobile (United States), SFR (France) and Vodafone
(Australia)

Manufacturers: Nokia, Kyocera, Sony Ericsson, Siemens, Samsung, Panasonic
and PalmOne

Dealers and Agents: Wireless One (United States), One Stop Cellular (United
States), Moorehead Communications (United States), First Mobile Group (New
Zealand) and MV2 Telecoms Shop (Philippines)

Mass Retailers: Best Buy (United States), Target (United States),
Pressbyran (Sweden), Karstadt (Sweden), Dialect (Sweden), Klartsvar
(Sweden) and Woolworth's Group (Australia)

Other Distributors: Computech Overseas International (Hong Kong), Charmley
Trading Pte. Ltd (Singapore), HCT Holdings Limited (Hong Kong), American
Connections (United States) and Infosonics (United States)

For both 2003 and 2002, aggregate revenues generated from our five
largest customers accounted for approximately 31% of our total revenue. In 2003,
Computech Overseas International ("Computech"), a customer of our Brightpoint
Asia Limited operations, accounted for approximately 10% of our total revenue
and 19% of our Asia-Pacific division's revenue. At December 31, 2003, there were
no amounts owed to us from Computech. In 2002, Computech accounted for
approximately 12% of our total revenue and 30% of our Asia-Pacific division's
revenue. At December 31, 2002, there were no amounts owed to us from Computech.
No single customer accounted for more than 10% or more of our total revenues in
2001. The loss or a significant reduction in business activities by our
customers could have a material adverse affect on our revenue and results of
operations.

We generally sell our products pursuant to customer purchase orders and
subject to our terms and conditions. We generally ship products on the same day
orders are received from the customer. Unless otherwise requested, substantially
all of our products are delivered by common carriers. Because orders are filled
shortly after receipt, backlog is generally not material to our business. Our
integrated logistics services are typically provided pursuant to agreements with
terms between one and three years which generally may be terminated by either
party subject to a short notice period.


PURCHASING AND SUPPLIERS

We have established key relationships with leading manufacturers of
wireless voice and data equipment such as Nokia, Motorola, Kyocera, Audiovox,
Sony Ericsson, Siemens, Samsung, Panasonic


8


and PalmOne. We generally negotiate directly with manufacturers and suppliers in
order to obtain inventories of brand name products. In 2003, we made purchases
from more than 200 wireless mobile device and accessory suppliers. Inventory
purchases are based on customer demand, product availability, brand name
recognition, price, service, and quality. Certain of our suppliers may provide
favorable purchasing terms to us, including credit, price protection,
cooperative advertising, volume incentive rebates, stock balancing and marketing
allowances. Product manufacturers typically provide limited warranties, which we
generally pass through to our customers.

Nokia, our largest supplier of wireless devices and accessories,
accounted for approximately 79%, 69% and 72% of purchases for our product
distribution business in 2003, 2002, and 2001, respectively. None of our other
suppliers accounted for 10% or more of product purchases in 2003, 2002 or 2001.
Loss of the applicable contracts with Nokia or other suppliers, or failure by
Nokia or other suppliers to supply competitive products on a timely basis, at
competitive prices and on favorable terms, or at all, would have a material
adverse effect on our revenue and operating margins and our ability to obtain
and deliver products on a timely and competitive basis. See -"COMPETITION."

We maintain agreements with certain of our significant suppliers, all
of which relate to specific geographic areas. Our agreements may be subject to
certain conditions and exceptions including the retention by manufacturers of
certain direct accounts and restrictions regarding our sale of products supplied
by certain other competing manufacturers and to certain wireless network
operators. Typically our agreements with suppliers are non-exclusive. Our supply
agreements may require us to satisfy purchase requirements based upon forecasts
provided by us, in which a portion of these forecasts may be binding. Our supply
agreements generally can be terminated on short notice by either party. We
purchase products from manufacturers pursuant to purchase orders placed from
time to time in the ordinary course of business. Purchase orders are typically
filled, subject to product availability, and shipped to our designated
warehouses by common carriers. In December of 2002, we entered into an amendment
to our distribution agreement with Nokia Inc. in the United States that, among
other provisions, changed certain purchasing and invoicing processes to create a
"Just-in-Time" inventory arrangement that allowed us to reduce the amount of
inventories of Nokia products that we owned prior to the expiration of this
arrangement in June 2003. This arrangement did not have a significant impact on
our December 31, 2002 or December 31, 2003 inventory carrying values. We believe
that our relationships with our suppliers are generally good, however, we have
from time to time experienced inadequate product supply from certain
manufacturers and network operators, including an inadequate supply of CDMA
products during the first half of 2003 from our key supplier in the United
States. Any failure or delay by our suppliers in supplying us with products on
favorable terms and at competitive prices would severely diminish our ability to
obtain and deliver products to our customers on a timely and competitive basis.
If we lose any of our significant suppliers, or if any supplier imposes
substantial price increases or eliminates favorable terms provided to us and
alternative sources of supply are not readily available, it may have a material
adverse effect on our results of operations.


SALES AND MARKETING

We promote our product lines, our capabilities and the benefits of
certain of our service lines through advertising in trade publications and
attending various international, national and regional trade


9


shows, as well as through direct mail solicitation, broadcast faxing and
telemarketing activities. Our suppliers and customers use a variety of methods
to promote their products and services directly to consumers, including print
and media advertising.

Our sales and marketing efforts are coordinated in each of our three
regional divisions by key personnel responsible for that particular division.
Divisional management devotes a substantial amount of their time to developing
and maintaining relationships with our customers and suppliers. In addition to
managing the overall operations of the divisions, each division's sales and
operations centers are managed by either general or country managers who report
to the appropriate member of divisional management and are responsible for the
daily sales and operations of their particular location. Each country has sales
associates who specialize in or focus on sales of our products and services to a
specific customer or customer category (e.g., network operator, dealers and
agents, reseller, retailer, subscriber, etc.). In addition, in many markets we
have dedicated a sales force to manage most of our wireless network operator
relationships and to promote our integrated logistics services. Sales and
marketing efforts for our Brightpoint Asia Limited operations have been
outsourced to Persequor Limited, to whom we pay a management fee, including
performance based commissions. Persequor Limited is controlled by the former
Managing Director of the Company's operations in the Middle East and certain
members of his management team. Persequor Limited is a 15% partner in
Brightpoint India Private Limited and oversees our Brightpoint India Private
Limited's operations. Including support and retail outlet personnel, we had
approximately 311 employees involved in sales and marketing at December 31,
2003, including 127 in our Americas division, 104 in our Europe division, and 80
in our Asia-Pacific division.

SEASONALITY

The operating results of each of our three divisions may be influenced
by a number of seasonal factors in the different countries and markets in which
we operate. These factors may cause our revenue and operating results to
fluctuate on a quarterly basis. These fluctuations are a result of several
factors, including, but not limited to:

o promotions and subsidies by wireless network operators;

o the timing of local holidays and other events affecting
consumer demand;

o the timing of the introduction of new products by our
suppliers and competitors;

o purchasing patterns of customers in different markets;

o general economic conditions; and

o product availability and pricing.

Consumer electronics and retail sales in many geographic markets tend
to experience increased volumes of sales at the end of the calendar year,
largely because of gift-giving holidays. This and other seasonal factors have
contributed to increases in our revenue during the fourth quarter in certain
markets. Conversely, we have experienced decreases in demand in the first
quarter subsequent to the higher level of activity in the preceding fourth
quarter. Our operating results may continue to fluctuate significantly in the
future. We believe a more accurate indicator of seasonal patterns is the number
of wireless devices we handle which we report as one of our key performance
indicators. If unanticipated events occur, including delays in securing adequate
inventories of competitive products at times of peak sales or significant
decreases in sales during these periods, it could have a material adverse effect
on our operating results. In addition, as a result of seasonal factors, interim
results may not be indicative of


10


annual results. See "MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS" for additional analysis on seasonality.

COMPETITION

We operate in a highly competitive industry and in highly competitive
markets and believe that such competition may intensify in the future. The
markets for wireless voice and data products are characterized by intense price
competition and significant price erosion over the lives of products. We compete
principally on the basis of value, in terms of price, time, product knowledge,
reliability, customer service and product availability. Our distribution
business competes with broad-based wireless distributors who carry similar
product lines and specialty distributors who may focus on segments within the
wireless industry such as accessories. To a lesser extent we compete with
information technology distribution companies who offer wireless devices in
certain markets. Manufacturers will typically sell their products directly to
large wireless network operators. As network operator customers grow in scale,
manufacturers may pose a competitive threat to our business. Manufacturers can
also offer fulfillment services to our customers, which compete with our
distribution and integrated logistics services businesses. Our integrated
logistics services business competes with general logistics services companies
who provide logistics services to multiple industries and specialize more in the
warehousing and transportation of finished goods. Certain wireless network
operators have their own distribution and logistics infrastructure which
competes with our outsource solutions offered by our integrated logistics
services business. These companies may possess substantially greater financial,
marketing, personnel and other resources than we do. Manufacturers other than
those that have historically produced wireless devices and accessories are also
entering the market to produce various wireless mobile devices, including
wireless data devices. Their entry is creating new competitors for distribution
and provision of integrated logistics services for these new products. Certain
of these competitors have the financial resources necessary to withstand
substantial price competition and could implement extensive advertising and
promotional campaigns, both generally and in response to efforts by additional
competitors to enter into new markets or introduce new products. The wireless
device industry is segmenting its product offering and is introducing products
that compete with other non-wireless consumer electronic products. Examples
include wireless devices with embedded cameras, which now compete to a certain
extent with non-wireless digital cameras and wireless devices with video gaming
features that compete with non-wireless handheld video game products. The
non-wireless consumer electronic products are distributed through other
non-wireless distributors who may become our competitors.

Competitors in our Americas division include wireless equipment
manufacturers, network operators and other dedicated wireless distributors such
as CellStar Corporation and BrightStar Corporation. We also compete with
logistics service providers in our Americas division, such as Communications
Test Design, Inc., UPS Logistics, Aftermarket Technologies Inc., Tessco
Technologies and American Wireless. In the Asia-Pacific market, our primary
competitors are United States-based and foreign-based exporters, traders and
distributors, including Tech Pacific Group, CellStar Corporation and Cellnet
Group Ltd. In our Europe division, our competitors include wireless equipment
manufacturers that sell directly to the region's wireless network operators and
retailers, wireless network operators themselves, and traders and other
distributors, such as Dangaard Telecom Holding A/S, Caudwell Communications
Limited, and Avenir S.A., and logistics and transportation companies such as


11


TPG NV and Bertelsmann AG. Additionally, in certain markets across all of our
divisions we compete with other electronics equipment distributors, such as
Ingram Micro Inc. and Tech Data Corporation.

The distribution of wireless devices and the provision of integrated
logistics services within the global wireless industry have, in the past, been
characterized by relatively low barriers to entry. Our ability to continue to
compete successfully will be largely dependent on our ability to anticipate and
respond to various competitive and other factors affecting the industry,
including new or changing outsourcing requirements; new information technology
requirements; new product introductions; inconsistent or inadequate supply of
product; changes in consumer preferences; demographic trends; international,
national, regional and local economic conditions; and discount pricing
strategies and promotional activities by competitors.

The markets for wireless communications products and integrated
services are characterized by rapidly changing technology and evolving industry
standards, often resulting in product obsolescence or short product life cycles.
Accordingly, our success is dependent upon our ability to anticipate
technological changes in the industry and successfully identify these changes
and adapt our offering of products and services, to satisfy evolving industry
and customer requirements. The use of alternative wireless telecommunications
technologies or the convergence of wireless telecommunications and computer
technologies may reduce demand for existing wireless telecommunications products
and lessen the demand for our services. Upon widespread commercial introduction,
new wireless communications or convergent technologies could materially change
the types of products sold by us and our suppliers and result in significant
price competition. In addition, products that reach the market outside of normal
distribution channels, such as "gray market" resales (e.g., unauthorized resales
or illegal resales, which may avoid applicable duties and taxes), may also have
an adverse impact on our operations.

INFORMATION SYSTEMS

The success of our operations is largely dependent on the
functionality, architecture, performance and utilization of our information
systems. We have, and continue to implement, business applications that enable
us to provide our customers and suppliers with solutions in the distribution of
their products. These solutions include, but are not limited to, e-commerce;
electronic data interchange (EDI); Web-based order entry, account management,
supply chain management; warehouse management, serialized inventory tracking,
inventory management, and reporting. During 2003, 2002 and 2001, we invested
approximately $5.2 million, $6.2 million and $22 million, respectively, on our
information systems focusing on enhancing our current solutions by increasing
the functionality and flexibility of our systems. In the future, we intend to
invest to further develop those solutions and integrate our internal information
systems throughout all divisions. At December 31, 2003, there were approximately
61 employees in our information technology departments worldwide.

EMPLOYEES

As of December 31, 2003, we had approximately 1,153 employees; 655 in
our Americas division, 284 in our Asia-Pacific division, and 215 in our Europe
division. Of these employees, approximately 5 were in executive officer
positions, 311 were engaged in sales and marketing, 564 were


12


in service operations and 273 were in finance and administration (including
information technology employees). Our distribution activities and integrated
logistics services are labor-intensive and we utilize temporary laborers,
particularly in our Americas division. At December 31, 2003, we had
approximately 407 temporary laborers; 52 in our Asia-Pacific division, 13 in our
Europe division and 342 in our Americas division. Of these temporary laborers,
approximately 35 were engaged in sales and marketing, 332 were in service
operations and 40 were in finance and administration. None of our United
States-based employees are covered by a collective bargaining agreement. We
believe that our relations with our employees are good. See BUSINESS RISK
FACTORS -- "OUR LABOR FORCE EXPERIENCES A HIGH RATE OF PERSONNEL TURNOVER" and
"WE ARE SUBJECT TO A NUMBER OF REGULATORY AND CONTRACTUAL RESTRICTIONS GOVERNING
OUR RELATIONS WITH CERTAIN OF OUR EMPLOYEES."

BUSINESS RISK FACTORS

There are many important factors that have affected, and in the future
could affect, our business, including the factors discussed below which should
be reviewed carefully, in conjunction with the other information contained in
this Form 10-K. Some of these factors are beyond our control and future trends
are difficult to predict. In addition, various statements, discussions and
analyses throughout this Form 10-K are not based on historical fact and contain
forward-looking statements. These statements are also subject to certain risks
and uncertainties, including those discussed below, which could cause our actual
results to differ materially from those expressed or implied in any
forward-looking statements made by us. Readers are cautioned not to place undue
reliance on any forward-looking statement contained in this Form 10-K and should
also be aware that we undertake no obligation to update any forward-looking
information contained herein to reflect events or circumstances after the date
of this Form 10-K or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events.

The loss or reduction in orders from principal customers or a reduction
in prices we are able to charge these customers could materially adversely
affect our business. -- For 2003 and 2002, aggregate revenues generated from our
five largest customers accounted for approximately 31% of our total revenues in
both years. In 2003, Computech, a distribution services customer of our
Brightpoint Asia Limited operations accounted for approximately 10% of our total
revenue and 19% of our Asia-Pacific division revenues. In 2002, Computech
represented 12% of our total revenue and 30% of the Asia-Pacific division's
revenue. In 2001, there were no customers over 10% of total revenue. In
addition, Nextel Communications, a customer in our Americas division represents
a significant portion of our integrated logistics services in the United States.
Many of these principal and other customers in the markets we serve have
experienced severe price competition and for this and other reasons may seek to
obtain products or services from us at lower prices than we have been able to
obtain from these customers in the past. The loss of any of our principal
customers, a reduction in the amount of product or services our principal
customers order from us or the inability to maintain current terms, including
price, with these or other customers could have an adverse effect on our
financial condition, results of operations and liquidity. Although we have
entered into contracts with certain of our largest integrated logistic service
customers, we have experienced losses of certain of these customers through
expiration or cancellation of these contracts and there can be no assurance that
any of our customers will continue to purchase products or services from us or
that their purchases will be at the same or greater levels than in prior
periods.


13


We buy a significant amount of our products from a limited number of
suppliers, who may not provide us with competitive products at reasonable prices
when we need them in the future. -- We purchase wireless devices and accessories
that we sell from wireless communications equipment manufacturers, distributors
and network operators. We depend on these suppliers to provide us with adequate
inventories of currently popular brand name products on a timely basis and on
favorable pricing and other terms. Our agreements with our suppliers generally
are non-exclusive, require us to satisfy minimum purchase requirements, can be
terminated on short notice and provide for certain territorial restrictions, as
is common in our industry. We generally purchase products pursuant to purchase
orders placed from time to time in the ordinary course of business. In the
future, our suppliers may not offer us competitive products on favorable terms
without delays. From time to time we have been unable to obtain sufficient
product supplies from manufacturers in many markets in which we operate. Any
future failure or delay by our suppliers in supplying us with products on
favorable terms would severely diminish our ability to obtain and deliver
products to our customers on a timely and competitive basis. If we lose any of
our principal suppliers, or if these suppliers are unable to fulfill our product
needs, or if any principal supplier imposes substantial price increases and
alternative sources of supply are not readily available, it would have a
material adverse effect on our results of operations.

We may have difficulty collecting our accounts receivable. -- We
currently offer and intend to offer open account terms to certain of our
customers, which may subject us to credit risks, particularly in the event that
any receivables represent sales to a limited number of customers or are
concentrated in particular geographic markets. We also enter into certain
securitization transactions with financing organizations with respect to
portions of our accounts receivable in order to reduce the amount of working
capital required to fund such receivables. We are the collection agent on behalf
of the financing organization for many of these arrangements. We have no
significant retained interest or servicing liabilities related to accounts
receivable that we have sold, although in limited circumstances, related
primarily to our performance in the original transactions, we may be required to
repurchase the accounts. The collection of our accounts receivable and our
ability to accelerate our collection cycle through the sale of accounts
receivable is effected by several factors, including, but not limited to, our
credit granting policies, contractual provisions, our customers' and our overall
credit rating as determined by various credit rating agencies, industry and
economic conditions, the ability of the customer to provide security, collateral
or guarantees relative to credit granted by us, the customer's and our recent
operating results, financial position and cash flows and our ability to obtain
credit insurance on amounts that we are owed. Adverse changes in any of these
factors, certain of which may not be wholly in our control, could create delays
in collecting or an inability to collect our accounts receivable which could
have a material adverse effect on our financial position, cash flows and results
of operations.

Our future operating results will depend on our ability to continue to
increase our sales significantly. -- A large percentage of our total revenues is
derived from sales of wireless devices, a part of our business that operates on
a high-volume, low-margin basis. Our ability to generate these sales is based
upon demand for wireless voice and data products and our having adequate supply
of these products. The gross margins that we realize on sales of wireless
devices could be reduced due to increased competition or a growing industry
emphasis on cost containment. Therefore, our future profitability will depend on
our ability to maintain our margins or to increase our sales to help offset
future declines in margins. We may not be able to maintain existing margins for
products or services offered by us or increase our sales. Even if our sales
rates do increase, the gross margins that we receive from our sales may not be
sufficient to make our future operations profitable.


14


The market price of our common stock may continue to be volatile. --
The market price of our common stock has fluctuated significantly from time to
time since our initial public offering in April 1994. The trading price of our
common stock could experience significant fluctuations in the future in response
to certain factors, which could include actual or anticipated variations in our
quarterly operating results or financial position; restatements of previously
issued financial statements; outcome or commencement of litigation; the
introduction of new services, products or technologies by us, our suppliers or
our competitors; changes in other conditions or trends in the wireless voice and
data industry; changes in governmental regulation and the enforcement of such
regulation; changes in the assessment of our credit rating as determined by
various credit rating agencies; or changes in securities analysts' estimates of
our future performance or that of our competitors or our industry in general.
General market price declines or market volatility in the prices of stocks for
companies in the global wireless industry or in the distribution or integrated
logistics services sectors of the global wireless industry could also affect the
market price of our common stock.

Our business depends on the continued tendency of wireless equipment
manufacturers and network operators to outsource aspects of their business to us
in the future. -- We provide functions such as distribution, inventory
management, fulfillment, customized packaging, prepaid and e-commerce solutions,
activation management and other outsourced services for many of these wireless
manufacturers and network operators. Certain wireless equipment manufacturers
and network operators have elected, and others may elect, to undertake these
services internally. Additionally, our customer service levels, industry
consolidation, competition, deregulation, technological changes or other
developments could reduce the degree to which members of the global wireless
industry rely on outsourced integrated logistics services such as the services
we provide. Any significant change in the market for our outsourced services
could have a material adverse effect on our business. Our outsourced services
are generally provided under multi-year renewable contractual arrangements.
Service periods under certain of our contractual arrangements are expiring or
will expire in the near future. The failure to obtain renewal or otherwise
maintain these agreements on terms, including price, consistent with our current
terms could have a material adverse effect on our business.

Our business may be adversely impacted by consolidation of wireless
network operators. -- The past several years have witnessed a consolidation
within the wireless network operator community which trend is expected to
continue. This trend could result in a reduction or elimination of promotional
activities by the remaining wireless network operators as they seek to reduce
their expenditures, which could in turn, result in decreased demand for our
products or services. Moreover, consolidation of wireless network operators
reduces the number of potential contracts available to us and other providers of
integrated logistic services. We could also lose business if wireless network
operators, which are our customers, are acquired by other wireless network
operators that are not our customers.

Our operations may be materially affected by fluctuations in regional
demand patterns and economic factors. -- The demand for our products and
services has fluctuated and may continue to vary substantially within the
regions served by us. We believe the roll-out of 3G systems and other new
technologies, which has been delayed and could further be delayed, has had and
will continue to have an effect on overall subscriber growth and handset
replacement demand. Economic slow-downs in regions served by us or changes in
promotional programs offered by wireless network operators may lower consumer
demand and create higher levels of inventories in our distribution channels
which results in lower than anticipated demand for the products and services
that we offer and can decrease our gross and


15


operating margins. During 2001 and 2002, we recorded inventory valuation
adjustments to adjust inventories to their estimated net realizable value based
on the then current market conditions. These valuation adjustments were the
result of the over-supply of product in our distribution channel and the
lower-than-anticipated level of demand. We believe our operations were adversely
affected by an economic slow-down in the United States during 2001 and
continuing through most of 2002. In 2003, the economy began to recover. However,
there are no assurances that this recovery will continue. A prolonged economic
slow-down in the United States or any other regions in which we have significant
operations could negatively impact our results of operations and financial
position.

Rapid technological changes in the global wireless industry could have
a material adverse effect on our business. -- The technology relating to
wireless voice and data equipment changes rapidly resulting in product
obsolescence or short product life cycles. We are required to anticipate future
technological changes in our industry and to continually identify, obtain and
market new products in order to satisfy evolving industry and customer
requirements. Competitors or manufacturers of wireless equipment may market
products which have perceived or actual advantages over products that we handle
or which otherwise render those products obsolete or less marketable. We have
made and continue to make significant capital investments in accordance with
evolving industry and customer requirements including maintaining levels of
inventories of currently popular products that we believe are necessary based on
current market conditions. These concentrations of capital increase our risk of
loss due to product obsolescence.

We rely on our suppliers to provide trade credit facilities to
adequately fund our on-going operations and product purchases. -- Our business
is dependent on our ability to obtain adequate supplies of currently popular
product at favorable pricing and on other favorable terms. Our ability to fund
our product purchases is dependent on our principal suppliers providing
favorable payment terms that allow us to maximize the efficiency of our capital
usage. The payment terms we receive from our suppliers is dependent on several
factors, including, but not limited to, our payment history with the supplier,
the suppliers credit granting policies, contractual provisions, our overall
credit rating as determined by various credit rating agencies, industry
conditions, our recent operating results, financial position and cash flows and
the supplier's ability to obtain credit insurance on amounts that we owe them.
Adverse changes in any of these factors, certain of which may not be wholly in
our control, could have a material adverse effect on our operations.

A significant percentage of our revenues is generated outside of North
America in countries that may have volatile currencies or other risks. -- We
maintain operations centers and sales offices in territories and countries
outside of the United States. The fact that our business operations are
conducted in a wide variety of countries exposes us to increased credit risks,
customs duties, import quotas and other trade restrictions, potentially greater
inflationary pressures, shipping delays, the risk of failure or material
interruption of wireless systems and services, possible wireless product supply
interruption and potentially significant increases in wireless product prices.
Changes may occur in social, political, regulatory and economic conditions or in
laws and policies governing foreign trade and investment in the territories and
countries where we currently have operations. U.S. laws and regulations relating
to investment and trade in foreign countries could also change to our detriment.
Any of these factors could have a material adverse effect on our business and
operations. We purchase and sell products and services in a number of foreign
currencies, many of which have experienced fluctuations in currency exchange
rates. On occasion, we enter into forward exchange swaps, futures or options
contracts as a


16


means of hedging our currency transaction and balance sheet translation
exposures. However, our management has had limited prior experience in engaging
in these types of transactions. Even if done well, hedging may not effectively
limit our exposure to a decline in operating results due to foreign currency
translation. We cannot predict the effect that future exchange rate fluctuations
will have on our operating results. We have ceased operations or divested
several of our foreign operations because they were not performing to acceptable
levels. These actions resulted in significant losses to us. We may in the
future, decide to divest certain existing foreign operations. This could result
in our incurring significant additional losses.

We rely on a third party to manage certain significant operations in
our Asia Pacific division. -- Sales and management services in our Brightpoint
Asia Limited operations are currently provided to us by Persequor Limited, an
entity controlled by the former Managing Director of our operations in the
Middle East and certain members of his management team and to whom we pay
certain management fees and performance-based bonuses. A failure of this entity
to provide us with satisfactory services or if these operations are negatively
impacted by other events could result in a loss of revenue generated from that
division which could adversely affect our revenue. In addition, Persequor
Limited is a 15% partner in Brightpoint India Private Limited and is a party to
a management services agreement for our India operations.

Hostilities and terrorist acts could disrupt our operations. --
Although we have implemented policies and procedures designed to minimize the
effect of an outbreak of hostilities or terrorist attacks in markets served by
us or on our facilities, the actual effect of any such events on our operations
cannot be determined at this time but our operations could be adversely
affected.

We make significant investments in the technology used in our business
and rely on this technology to function effectively without interruptions. -- We
have made significant investments in information systems technology and have
focused on the application of this technology to provide customized integrated
logistics services to wireless communications equipment manufacturers and
network operators. Our ability to meet our customers' technical and performance
requirements is highly dependent on the effective functioning of our information
technology systems. Further, certain of our contractual arrangements to provide
services contain performance measures and criteria that if not met could result
in early termination of the agreement and claims for damages. In connection with
the implementation of this technology we have incurred significant costs and
have experienced significant business interruptions. These business
interruptions can cause us to fall below acceptable performance levels pursuant
to our customers' requirements and could result in the loss of the related
business relationship. In 2001, difficulties with our information systems
implementation contributed to the loss of a new integrated logistics services
customer and also resulted in a claim being filed against us. We may continue to
experience additional costs and periodic business interruptions related to our
information systems as we implement new information systems in our various
operations. Our sales and marketing efforts, a large part of which are
telemarketing based, are highly dependent on computer and telephone equipment.
We anticipate that we will need to continue to invest significant amounts to
enhance our information systems in order to maintain our competitiveness and to
develop new logistics services. Our property and business interruption insurance
may not compensate us adequately, or at all, for losses that we may incur if we
lose our equipment or systems either temporarily or permanently. In addition, a
significant increase in the costs of additional technology or telephone services
that is not recoverable


17


through an increase in the price of our services could have a material adverse
effect on our results of operations.

We have outstanding indebtedness, which is secured by a portion of our
assets and which could prevent us from borrowing additional funds, if needed. --
Our United States, Australia and New Zealand subsidiaries' credit facilities are
secured by primarily all of their respective assets and borrowing availability
is based primarily on a percentage of eligible accounts receivable and
inventory. Consequently, any significant decrease in eligible accounts
receivable and inventory could limit our subsidiaries' ability to borrow
additional funds to adequately finance our operations and expansion strategies.
The terms of our United States, Australia and New Zealand subsidiaries' credit
facilities also include negative covenants that, among other things, limit our
ability to incur additional indebtedness, sell certain assets and make certain
payments, including but not limited to, dividends, repurchases of common stock
and other payments outside the normal course of business as well as prohibiting
us from merging or consolidating with another corporation or selling all or
substantially all of our assets in the United States, Australia and New Zealand.
If we violate any of these loan covenants, default on these obligations or
become subject to a change of control, our subsidiaries' indebtedness would
become immediately due and payable, and the banks could foreclose on its
security.

The global wireless industry is intensely competitive and we may not be
able to continue to compete successfully in this industry. -- We compete for
sales of wireless voice and data equipment, and expect that we will continue to
compete, with numerous well-established wireless network operators, distributors
and manufacturers, including our own suppliers. As a provider of integrated
logistics services, we also compete with other distributors, logistics services
companies and electronic manufacturing services companies. Many of our
competitors possess greater financial and other resources than we do and may
market similar products or services directly to our customers. The global
wireless industry has generally had low barriers to entry. As a result,
additional competitors may choose to enter our industry in the future. The
markets for wireless handsets and accessories are characterized by intense price
competition and significant price erosion over the life of a product. Many of
our competitors have the financial resources to withstand substantial price
competition and to implement extensive advertising and promotional programs,
both generally and in response to efforts by additional competitors to enter
into new markets or introduce new products. Our ability to continue to compete
successfully will depend largely on our ability to maintain our current industry
relationships. We may not be successful in anticipating and responding to
competitive factors affecting our industry, including new or changing
outsourcing requirements, the entry of additional well-capitalized competitors,
new products which may be introduced, changes in consumer preferences,
demographic trends, international, national, regional and local economic
conditions and competitors' discount pricing and promotion strategies. As
wireless telecommunications markets mature and as we seek to enter into new
markets and offer new products in the future, the competition that we face may
change and grow more intense.

We may not be able to manage and sustain future growth at our
historical or current rates. -- In prior years we have experienced domestic and
international growth. We will need to manage our expanding operations
effectively, maintain or accelerate our growth as planned and integrate any new
businesses which we may acquire into our operations successfully in order to
continue our desired growth. If we are unable to do so, particularly in
instances in which we have made significant capital investments, it could have a
material adverse effect on our operations. In addition, our growth prospects
could be adversely affected by a decline in the global wireless industry
generally or in one of our


18


regional divisions, either of which could result in reduction or deferral of
expenditures by prospective customers.

Our business strategy includes entering into relationships and
financings, which may provide us with minimal returns or losses on our
investments. -- We have entered into several relationships and joint ventures
with wireless equipment manufacturers, network operators and other participants
in our industry. We intend to continue to enter into similar relationships as
opportunities arise. We may enter into distribution or integrated logistics
services agreements with these parties and may provide them with equity or debt
financing. Our ability to achieve future profitability through these
relationships will depend in part upon the economic viability, success and
motivation of the entities we select as partners and the amount of time and
resources that these partners devote to our alliances. We may receive minimal or
no business from these relationships and joint ventures, and any business we
receive may not be significant or at the level we anticipated. The returns we
receive from these relationships, if any, may not offset possible losses or our
investments or the full amount of financings that we make upon entering into
these relationships. We may not achieve acceptable returns on our investments
with these parties within an acceptable period or at all.

We have incurred significant losses in recent years. -- For the years
ended December 31, 2001 and 2002 we incurred net losses of $53 million and $42
million, respectively. The net losses for 2001 and 2002 include approximately
$56 million and $15 million, respectively, of losses related to discontinued
operations. Also included in the net loss in 2002 is the cumulative effect of a
change in accounting principle, net of tax, of $41 million. Several business
factors have contributed to our losses in these periods including costs related
to our restructuring plans, adjustments to the carrying value of certain
inventories, an inadequate supply of products for sale through our distribution
services, inadequate demand for our products and services, costs related to the
implementation of information systems and an impairment loss on a long-term
investment. We may incur additional future losses.

Our operating results frequently vary significantly and respond to
seasonal fluctuations in purchasing patterns. -- The operating results of each
of our three divisions may be influenced by a number of seasonal factors in the
different countries and markets in which we operate. These factors may cause our
revenue and operating results to fluctuate on a quarterly basis. These
fluctuations are a result of several factors, including, but not limited to:

o promotions and subsidies by wireless network operators;

o the timing of local holidays and other events affecting
consumer demand;

o the timing of the introduction of new products by our
suppliers and competitors;

o purchasing patterns of customers in different markets;

o general economic conditions; and

o product availability and pricing.

Consumer electronics and retail sales in many geographic markets tend
to experience increased volumes of sales at the end of the calendar year,
largely because of gift-giving holidays. This and other seasonal factors have
contributed to increases in our sales during the fourth quarter in certain
markets. Conversely, we have experienced decreases in demand in the first
quarter subsequent to the higher level of activity in the preceding fourth
quarter. Our operating results may continue to fluctuate significantly in the
future. We believe a more accurate indicator of seasonal patterns is the number
of wireless devices we handle which we report as one of our key performance
indicators. If unanticipated events occur,


19


including delays in securing adequate inventories of competitive products at
times of peak sales or significant decreases in sales during these periods, it
could have a material adverse effect on our operating results. In addition, as a
result of seasonal factors, interim results may not be indicative of annual
results. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and
Results of Operations" for additional analysis on seasonality.

Our continued growth depends on retaining our current key employees and
attracting additional qualified personnel. -- Our success depends in large part
on the abilities and continued service of our executive officers and other key
employees. Although we have entered into employment agreements with several of
our officers and employees, we may not be able to retain their services. We also
have non-competition agreements with our executive officers and some of our
existing key personnel. However, courts are sometimes reluctant to enforce
non-competition agreements. The loss of executive officers or other key
personnel could have a material adverse effect on us. In addition, in order to
support our continued growth, we will be required to effectively recruit,
develop and retain additional qualified management. If we are unable to attract
and retain additional necessary personnel, it could delay or hinder our plans
for growth.

We are subject to a number of regulatory and contractual restrictions
governing our relations with certain of our employees. -- We are subject to a
number of regulatory and contractual restrictions governing our relations with
certain of our employees, including national collective labor agreements for
certain of our employees who are employed outside of the United States and
individual employer labor agreements. These arrangements address a number of
specific issues affecting our working conditions including hiring, work time,
wages and benefits, and termination of employment. We could be required to make
significant payments in order to comply with these requirements. The cost of
complying with these requirements may materially adversely affect our business
and financial condition.

Our labor force experiences a high rate of personnel turnover. -- Our
distribution activities and integrated logistics services are labor-intensive,
and we experience high personnel turnover and can be adversely affected by
shortages in the available labor force in geographical areas where we operate. A
significant portion of our labor force is contracted through temporary agencies
and a significant portion of our costs consists of wages to hourly workers.
Growth in our business, together with seasonal increases in net revenue,
requires us to recruit and train personnel at an accelerated rate from time to
time. We may not be able to continue to hire, train and retain a significant
labor force of qualified individuals when needed, or at all. An increase in
hourly costs, employee benefit costs, employment taxes or commission rates could
have a material adverse effect on our operations. In addition, if the turnover
rate among our labor force increased further, we could be required to increase
our recruiting and training efforts and costs, and our operating efficiencies
and productivity could decrease.

We rely to a great extent on trade secret and copyright laws and
agreements with our key employees and other third parties to protect our
proprietary rights. -- Our business success is substantially dependent upon our
proprietary business methods and software applications relating to our
information systems. We currently hold one patent relating to certain of our
business methods. Concerning other business methods and software we rely on
trade secret and copyright laws to protect our proprietary knowledge. We also
regularly enter into non-disclosure agreements with our key employees and limit
access to and distribution of our trade secrets and other proprietary
information. These measures may not prove adequate to prevent misappropriation
of our technology. Our competitors


20


could also independently develop technologies that are substantially equivalent
or superior to our technology, thereby eliminating one of our competitive
advantages. We also have offices and conduct our operations in a wide variety of
countries outside the United States. The laws of some other countries do not
protect our proprietary rights to the same extent, as do laws in the United
States. In addition, although we believe that our business methods and
proprietary software have been developed independently and do not infringe upon
the rights of others, third parties might assert infringement claims against us
in the future or our business methods and software may be found to infringe upon
the proprietary rights of others.

We have significant future payment obligations pursuant to certain
leases and other long-term contracts. -- We lease our office and
warehouse/distribution facilities as well as certain furniture and equipment
under real property and personal equipment leases. Many of these leases are for
terms that exceed one year and require us to pay significant monetary charges
for early termination or breach by us of the lease terms. We cannot be certain
of our ability to adequately fund these lease commitments from our future
operations and our decision to modify, change or abandon any of our existing
facilities could have a material adverse effect on our operations.

We may become subject to suits alleging medical risks associated with
our wireless handsets. -- Lawsuits or claims have been filed or made against
manufacturers of wireless handsets over the past years alleging possible medical
risks, including brain cancer, associated with the electromagnetic fields
emitted by wireless communications handsets. There has been only limited
relevant research in this area, and this research has not been conclusive as to
what effects, if any, exposure to electromagnetic fields emitted by wireless
handsets has on human cells. Substantially all of our revenues are derived,
either directly or indirectly, from sales of wireless handsets. We may become
subject to lawsuits filed by plaintiffs alleging various health risks from our
products. If any future studies find possible health risks associated with the
use of wireless handsets or if any damages claim against us is successful, it
could have a material adverse effect on our business. Even an unsubstantiated
perception that health risks exist could adversely affect our ability or the
ability of our customers to market wireless handsets.

We may be unable to obtain and maintain adequate business insurance at
a reasonable cost. -- Although we currently maintain general commercial and
property liability insurance in amounts we believe are appropriate it has become
increasingly difficult in recent years to obtain adequate insurance coverage at
a reasonable cost. Our operations could be adversely affected by a loss that is
not covered by insurance due to our inability in the future to obtain adequate
insurance. Moreover, increasing insurance premiums would adversely affect our
future operating results.

There are amounts of our securities, which are issuable pursuant to our
employee stock option, our Independent Director Stock Compensation and employee
stock purchase plans which could result in dilution to existing stockholders and
adversely affect the market price of our common stock. -- We have reserved a
significant number of shares of common stock that may be issuable pursuant to
our employee stock option, our Independent Director Stock Compensation and
employee stock purchase plans. In addition, we intend to seek to obtain
stockholder approval to adopt new stock incentive plans which will allow us to
issue additional securities to our employees, officers, directors and certain
others. These securities, when issued and outstanding, may reduce earnings per
share in periods that they are considered dilutive under Generally Accepted
Accounting Principles and, to the extent that they are


21


exercised and shares of common stock are issued, dilute percentage ownership to
existing stockholders which could have an adverse effect on the market price of
our common stock.

We have instituted measures to protect us against a takeover. --
Certain provisions of our By-laws, stockholders rights and option plans, certain
employment agreements and the Delaware General Corporation Law are designed to
protect us in the event of a takeover attempt. These provisions could prohibit
or delay mergers or attempted takeovers or changes in control of us and,
accordingly, may discourage attempts to acquire us.


SEGMENT AND GEOGRAPHIC FINANCIAL INFORMATION

Financial information concerning our segments and other geographic
financial information is included in "MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS" under the heading "OPERATING
SEGMENTS AND GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION" on page A-81 of this Annual Report on Form
10-K.


22

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES.

We provide our distribution and integrated logistics services from our
sales and operations centers located in various countries including Australia,
Colombia, France, Germany, India, Ireland, New Zealand, Norway, the Philippines,
Sweden, and the United States. All of these facilities are occupied pursuant to
operating leases. The table below summarizes information about our sales and
operations centers by operating division.



NUMBER OF AGGREGATE APPROXIMATE
LOCATIONS (1) SQUARE FOOTAGE MONTHLY RENT
------------- -------------- ------------

The Americas (2).................. 4 759,059 $ 433,000
Asia-Pacific...................... 5 111,934 55,000
Europe (3) (4).................... 14 165,092 175,000
-------- ------------- ------------
23 1,036,085 $ 663,000
======== ============= ============


(1) Refers to geographic areas in which we maintain facilities and
considers multiple buildings located in the same area as a single
geographic location.

(2) Includes the property lease related to the Richmond, California, call
center, which was consolidated into the Plainfield, Indiana, facility.

(3) Includes retail operations in France.

(4) Includes Ireland operation divested in February 2004.

During 2003, we consolidated our Richmond, California, call center
operation into our Plainfield, Indiana, facility to reduce costs and increase
productivity and profitability in our Americas division, which resulted in a
facility consolidation charge of $5.5 million during 2003. The operating lease
for the 58,000 square foot facility in Richmond, California, expires in March of
2009 with the average base rent of approximately $90,000 per month throughout
the remaining lease term. Since the announcement of the consolidation of the
Richmond, California, facility, the Company has been attempting to find a
sub-lessee for the property or terminate its liability.

We believe that our existing facilities are adequate for our current
requirements and that suitable additional space will be available as needed to
accommodate future expansion of our operations.


23


ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

In October 2003, the Company settled the action brought against it by
Chanin Capital Partners LLC ("Chanin") on November 25, 2002 in the United States
District Court for the Southern District of Indiana Civil Action No.
1:02-CV-1834-JDT-WTL. Pursuant to the settlement the Company paid Chanin
$725,000 and the action was dismissed with prejudice. Net of amounts accrued in
2002, an additional $100,000 was recorded as a loss on debt extinguishment.

In September 2003, the Company settled the investigation of certain
matters including our accounting treatment of a certain contract entered into
with an insurance company conducted by the SEC. Pursuant to the settlement, the
Company, without admitting or denying any of the SEC's allegations, consented to
the entry of an administrative order (the "Order") to cease and desist from
violations of the anti-fraud, books and records, internal controls and periodic
reporting provisions of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and the anti-fraud
provisions of the Securities Act of 1933. Pursuant to the terms of the Order,
the Company has undertaken and agreed to cooperate fully with the SEC in any and
all investigations, litigations or other proceedings relating to or arising from
the matters described in the Order. The Company also paid a fine of $450,000
pursuant to an order entered in the United States District Court for the
Southern District of New York. The Order alleged that the Company, through the
actions of John Delaney, its former Controller and Chief Accounting Officer and
Timothy Harcharik, its former Director of Risk Management, committed fraud
through the purchase and use of a purported insurance policy to misrepresent the
Company's losses as insured losses. The Company restated its annual financial
statements for 1998, 1999, 2000 and the interim periods of 2001 on November 13,
2001 and January 31, 2002 to account for payments made under the purported
insurance policy. Delaney and Phillip Bounsall, the Company's former Chief
Financial Officer, also reached settlements with the SEC. During the third
quarter of 2003 the fine was recorded in net other expense. The Company's
Certificate of Incorporation and By-laws provide that it indemnify its officers
and directors to the extent permitted by law. In connection therewith, the
Company entered into indemnification agreements with its executive officers and
directors. In accordance with the terms of these agreements the Company has
reimbursed certain of its former executive officers and intends to reimburse its
officers and directors for their legal fees and expenses incurred in connection
with certain pending litigation and regulatory matters. During 2003 and 2002,
pursuant to their respective indemnification agreements with Brightpoint, Inc.,
$26,606 and $93,280 in legal fees were paid on behalf of Phillip Bounsall and
$1,419 and $107,739 in legal fees were paid on behalf of John Delaney.

In the ordinary course of conducting its business, the Company is from
time to time, also involved in certain legal proceedings. While the ultimate
liability pursuant to these actions cannot currently be determined, the Company
believes these legal proceedings will not have a material adverse effect on its
financial statements, including earnings and liquidity.

The Company's Certificate of Incorporation and By-laws provide for it
to indemnify its officers and directors to the extent permitted by law. In
connection therewith, the Company has entered into indemnification agreements
with its executive officers and directors. In accordance with the terms of these
agreements, the Company has reimbursed certain of its former and current
executive officers and intends to reimburse its officers and directors for their
personal legal expenses arising from certain litigation and regulatory matters.


24


The Company's subsidiary in South Africa, whose operations were
discontinued pursuant to the 2001 Restructuring Plan, has received an assessment
from the South Africa Revenue Service ("SARS") regarding value-added taxes the
SARS claims are due, relating to certain product sale and purchase transactions
entered into by the Company's subsidiary in South Africa from 2000 to 2002.
Although the Company's liability pursuant to this assessment by the SARS, if
any, cannot currently be determined, the Company believes the range of the
potential liability is between $0 and $1.2 million U.S. dollars (at current
exchange rates) including penalties and interest. The potential assessment is
not estimable and, therefore, is not reflected as a liability or recorded as an
expense.

A complaint was filed on November 23, 2001 against us and 87 other
defendants in the United States District Court for the District of Arizona,
entitled Lemelson Medical, Education and Research Foundation LP v. Federal
Express Corporation, et.al., Cause No. CIV01-2287-PHX-PGR. The plaintiff claims
that we and other defendants have infringed 7 patents alleged to cover bar code
technology. The case seeks unspecified damages, treble damages and injunctive
relief. The Court has ordered the case stayed pending the decision in a related
case in which a number of bar code equipment manufacturers have sought a
declaration that the patents asserted are invalid and unenforceable. That trial
concluded in January 2003. In January 2004, the Court rendered its decision that
the patents asserted by Lemelson were found to be invalid and unenforceable. An
appeal by Lemelson is expected and we continue to dispute these claims and
intend to defend this matter vigorously.

ITEM 4. SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS.

Not Applicable.


25


PART II

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS.

The information required by this Item is set forth in "Equity
Compensation Plans" on page 41 and in "Other Information" on page A-84 of this
Annual Report on Form 10-K.

ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA.

The information required by this Item is set forth in "Selected
Financial Data" on page A-85 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS
OF OPERATIONS.

The information required by this Item is set forth on pages A-44 to
A-82 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK.

The information required by this Item is set forth in the subsection
"Financial Market Risk Management" of Management's Discussion and Analysis on
page A-83 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA.

The information required by this Item is set forth in our Consolidated
Financial Statements on pages A-4 to A-43 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND
FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE.

None.



26


ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

The Company, under the supervision and with the participation of its
management, including its principal executive officer and principal financial
officer, evaluated the effectiveness of the design and operation of its
disclosure controls and procedures as of the end of the period covered by this
report. Based on this evaluation, the principal executive officer and principal
financial officer concluded that the Company's disclosure controls and
procedures are effective in reaching a reasonable level of assurance that
information required to be disclosed by the Company in the reports that it files
or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and
reported within the time period specified in the Securities and Exchange
Commission's rules and forms.

The principal executive officer and principal financial officer also
conducted an evaluation of the Company's internal control over financial
reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(f)) ("Internal Control") to
determine whether any changes in Internal Control occurred during the quarter
ended December 31, 2003 that have materially affected or which are reasonably
likely to materially affect Internal Control. Based on that evaluation, there
has been no such change during such period.


27


PART III

ITEM 10. DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT

Our By-laws provide that our Board of Directors is divided into three
classes (Class I, Class II and Class III). At each Annual Meeting of
Stockholders, directors constituting one class are elected for a three-year
term. Each of the directors will be elected to serve until a successor is
elected and qualified or until the director's earlier resignation or removal.

The following table sets forth, for each director, the director's name,
age, principal occupation and length of continuous service as a Brightpoint
director:

CLASS I DIRECTORS
(Term Expires in 2004)



PRINCIPAL OCCUPATION
NAME OF NOMINEE AGE OR EMPLOYMENT DIRECTOR SINCE
--------------- --- -------------------- --------------

J. Mark Howell............... 39 President of the Company 1994
V. William Hunt.............. 59 Chairman, Hunt Capital Partners, LLC 2004
Stephen H. Simon............. 38 President and Chief Executive Officer, 1994
Melvin Simon & Associates, Inc.
Todd H. Stuart............... 38 Vice President and Director of Stuart's 1997
Moving and Storage, Inc.


CLASS II DIRECTORS
(Term Expires in 2005)



PRINCIPAL OCCUPATION
NAME OF DIRECTOR AGE OR EMPLOYMENT DIRECTOR SINCE
---------------- --- -------------------- --------------

Robert J. Laikin............. 40 Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive 1989
Officer of the Company
Robert F. Wagner............. 69 Partner of Law Firm of Lewis & Wagner 1994
Richard W. Roedel............ 54 Retired Chairman and Chief Executive Officer 2002
of BDO Seidman LLP



28


CLASS III DIRECTORS
(Term Expires in 2006)



PRINCIPAL OCCUPATION
NAME OF DIRECTOR AGE OR EMPLOYMENT DIRECTOR SINCE
---------------- --- -------------------- --------------

Catherine M. Daily........... 41 Professor, Kelley School of Business at 2002
Indiana University
Eliza Hermann................ 42 Vice President, Human Resources - Gas 2003
Power Renewables of BP plc
Marisa E. Pratt.............. 39 Vice President - Finance of Eli Lilly 2003
Canada
Jerre L. Stead............... 61 Retired Chairman and Chief Executive 2000
Officer of Ingram Micro Inc.


Set forth below is a description of the backgrounds of each of our
directors and executive officers:

Robert J. Laikin, founder of the Company, has been a director of the
Company since its inception in August 1989. Mr. Laikin has been Chairman of the
Board and Chief Executive Officer of the Company since January 1994. Mr. Laikin
was President of the Company from June 1992 until September 1996 and Vice
President and Treasurer of the Company from August 1989 until May 1992. From
July 1986 to December 1987, Mr. Laikin was Vice President and, from January 1988
to February 1993, President of Century Cellular Network, Inc., a company engaged
in the retail sale of cellular telephones and accessories.

J. Mark Howell has been a director of the Company since October 1994.
Mr. Howell has been President of the Company since September 1996 and Chief
Operating Officer of the Company from August 1995 to April 16, 1998 and from
July 16, 1998 to March 2003. He was Executive Vice President, Finance, Chief
Financial Officer, Treasurer and Secretary of the Company from July 1994 until
September 1996. From July 1992 until joining the Company, Mr. Howell was
Corporate Controller for ADESA Corporation, a company that owns and operates
automobile auctions in the United States and Canada. Prior thereto, Mr. Howell
was an accountant with Ernst & Young LLP.

Catherine M. Daily, has been a director of the Company since October
2002 and is currently Chairperson of the Company's Corporate Governance and
Nominating Committee. Since 1997, Ms. Daily has been a Professor at the Kelley
School of Business at Indiana University where she is currently the David H.
Jacobs Chair of Strategic Management. Prior thereto Ms. Daily served on the
faculties of Purdue University and The Ohio State University.

V. William Hunt was appointed as a Director of the Company in February
of 2004 and is a member of the Audit Committee. Mr. Hunt is Chairman, Hunt
Capital Partners, LLC, a venture capital and consulting firm based in
Indianapolis, and devotes a substantial amount of volunteer time to Indiana
University in its economic engagement initiatives, including the Central Indiana
Life Sciences Initiative


29


now known as BioCrossroads. Until August 2001, he was the Vice Chairman and
President of ArvinMeritor Inc., a global supplier of a broad range of integrated
systems, modules and components for light vehicle, commercial truck, trailer and
specialty original equipment manufacturers (OEMs) and related after-markets.
Prior to the July 2000 merger of Arvin Inc. and Meritor Automotive Inc., Mr.
Hunt was Chairman and CEO of Arvin, a global manufacturer of automotive
components, including exhaust systems; ride control products and air, oil and
fuel filters. Mr. Hunt joined Arvin as counsel in 1976, became Vice President,
Administration; Secretary in 1982; and Executive Vice President in 1990;
President in 1996; and CEO in 1998. A member of Arvin's board of directors since
1983, he was named Chairman in 1999. Before joining Arvin, Mr. Hunt practiced
labor relations law in Indianapolis and served as labor counsel to TRW
Automotive Worldwide.

Eliza Hermann, has been a director of the Company since January 2003
and is currently a member of the Company's Compensation and Human Resources
Committee. Since 1985, Ms. Hermann has been employed by BP plc where she serves
as the Vice President Human Resources - Gas Power and Renewables and previously
served as its Manager, Strategy and Business Transformation - Global Aromatics.

Marisa E. Pratt, has been a director of the Company since January 2003
and is currently a member of the Company's Audit Committee. Since 1991, Ms.
Pratt has been employed by Eli Lilly in various finance and treasury related
positions. Since October of 2002, Ms. Pratt has been Vice President - Finance of
Eli Lilly Canada.

Richard W. Roedel, has been a director and Chairman of the Company's
Audit Committee since October 2002 and currently is a member of the Company's
Corporate Governance and Nominating Committee. Mr. Roedel is a co-founder and
principal of Pinnacle Ventures LLC, which provides funding and management
expertise to privately held companies. From 1999 to 2000, Mr. Roedel was
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of the accounting firm BDO Seidman LLP, the
United States member firm of BDO International. Before becoming Chairman and
Chief Executive Officer, he was the Managing Partner of BDO Seidman's New York
Metropolitan Area from 1994 to 1999, the Managing Partner of its Chicago office
from 1990 to 1994 and an Audit Partner from 1985 to 1990. Mr. Roedel is a
Certified Public Accountant. Mr. Roedel is a director of Take-Two Interactive
Software, Inc. a manufacturer and marketer of video games, and Dade Behring
Holdings, Inc., a medical diagnostics equipment and related product
manufacturer.

Stephen H. Simon has been a director of the Company since April 1994
and is currently a member of the Company's Compensation and Human Resources
Committee. Mr. Simon has been President and Chief Executive Officer of Melvin
Simon & Associates, Inc., a privately-held shopping center development company,
since February 1997. From December 1993 until February 1997, Mr. Simon was
Director of Development for an affiliate of Simon Property Group, a
publicly-held real estate investment trust. From November 1991 to December 1993,
Mr. Simon was Development Manager of Melvin Simon & Associates, Inc.

Jerre L. Stead has been a director of the Company since June 2000 and
currently serves as the Company's Lead Independent Director and Chairperson of
the Company's Compensation and Human Resources Committee. He is also a member of
the Company's Corporate Governance and Nominating


30


Committee. From August 1996 to June 2000 Mr. Stead was Chairman of the Board of
Ingram Micro Inc., a worldwide distributor of information technology products
and services. Concurrently from August 1996 to March 2000, Mr. Stead served as
the Chief Executive Officer of Ingram Micro Inc. Mr. Stead served as Chairman,
President and Chief Executive Officer of Legent Corporation, a software
development company from January 1995 until its sale in September 1995. From
1993 to 1994, Mr. Stead was Executive Vice President of American Telephone and
Telegraph Company, a telecommunications company and Chairman and Chief Executive
Officer of AT&T Global Information Solutions, a computer and communications
company, formerly NCR Corp. He was President of AT&T Global Business
Communications Systems, a communications company, from 1991 to 1993. Mr. Stead
was Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer from 1989 to 1991 and
President from 1987 to 1989 of Square D Company, an industrial control and
electrical distribution products company. In addition, he held numerous
positions during a 21-year career at Honeywell. Mr. Stead is a Director of
Thomas & Betts Corp., Conexant Systems, Inc., Armstrong Holdings, Inc. and
Mobility Electronics, Inc.

Todd H. Stuart has been a director of the Company since November 1997
and is currently a member of the Company's Audit Committee. Mr. Stuart has been
Vice President, since May 1993, and Director of Transportation, since May 1985,
of Stuart's Moving and Storage, Inc., a provider of domestic and international
logistics and transportation services. Mr. Stuart is a director of National Bank
of Indianapolis.

Robert F. Wagner has been a director of the Company since April 1994
and is currently a member of the Company's Compensation and Human Resources
Committee. Mr. Wagner has been engaged in the practice of law with the firm of
Lewis & Wagner since 1973.

Frank Terence, age 45, has been Executive Vice President, Chief
Financial Officer and Treasurer of the Company since April 2002. From August
2001 through April 2002, Mr. Terence was the Chief Financial Officer of
Velocitel, LLC, a wireless telecommunications infrastructure company. From
January 2000 through January 2001, Mr. Terence was Chief Financial Officer of
eTranslate, Inc., web services company. From October 1994 through December 1999,
Mr. Terence was employed in various financial positions by Ingram Micro, Inc., a
technology distribution company, which included Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer of its Frameworks Division and Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer for its Latin America Division. From 1990 to 1994, he held
regional controllerships and financial management roles for Borland
International, a software development company. From 1983 to 1990, he held
various financial roles with NCR, Rockwell International and PepsiCo. Mr.
Terence is a Certified Management Accountant.

Steven E. Fivel, age 43, has been Executive Vice President, General
Counsel and Secretary of the Company since January 1997. From December 1993
until January 1997, Mr. Fivel was an attorney with an affiliate of Simon
Property Group, a publicly-held real estate investment trust. From February 1988
to December 1993, Mr. Fivel was an attorney with Melvin Simon & Associates,
Inc., a privately-held shopping center development company.

Lisa M. Kelley, age 37, has been Senior Vice President, Corporate
Controller and Chief Accounting Officer of the Company since July 2003. Ms.
Kelley was formerly with Plexus Corp., a provider of product realization
services to original equipment manufacturers. During her tenure with


31


Plexus from 1992 to June 2003, she held several financial positions including
VP-Corporate Development, VP-Finance, Corporate Controller and Treasurer. From
1986 to 1992, Ms. Kelley held various financial positions with Virchow Krause &
Company LLP, a Midwest certified public accounting firm. Ms. Kelley is a
Certified Public Accountant and a Certified Management Accountant.

AUDIT COMMITTEE AND FINANCIAL EXPERT

We have a separately designated standing audit committee established in
accordance with Section 3(a)(58)(A) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
comprised of Messrs. Hunt, Roedel (chairperson) and Stuart and Ms. Pratt, each
of whom is "independent" as defined under Item 7(d)(3)(iv) of Schedule 14A of
the Exchange Act and under applicable NASDAQ Marketplace Rules. Our Board of
Directors has determined that Mr. Roedel is an "audit committee financial
expert" as defined under Item 401(h) of Regulation S-K.

CODE OF BUSINESS CONDUCT

We have adopted a Code of Business Conduct that applies to our
employees, including our senior management, including our chief executive
officer, chief financial officer, controller and persons performing similar
functions. Copies of our Code of Business Conduct are available on our website
(www.brightpoint.com) and are also available without charge upon written request
directed to Investor Relations, Brightpoint, Inc., 501 Airtech Parkway,
Plainfield, Indiana 46168. If we make changes to our Code of Business Conduct in
any material respect or waive any provision of the Code of Business Conduct for
any of our senior financial officers, we expect to provide the public with
notice of any such change or waiver by publishing a description of such event on
our corporate website, www.brightpoint.com, or by other appropriate means as
required by applicable rules of the United States Securities and Exchange
Commission.

SECTION 16(a) BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP REPORTING COMPLIANCE

Based solely on a review of Forms 3, 4 and 5 and amendments thereto furnished to
us with respect to our most recent fiscal year, we believe that all required
reports were filed on a timely basis, with the following exceptions: Mr. Howell
filing a late Form 4 with respect to two sales aggregating 5,527 shares of our
common stock made by a family educational trust and; Mr. Anthony Boor, the
Americas division CFO, filing a late Form 4 with respect to a sale of 399 shares
made through our Employee Stock Purchase Plan.


32


ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE

The following table discloses for the periods presented the
compensation for the person who served as our Chief Executive Officer and for
each of our other executive officers (not including the Chief Executive Officer)
whose total individual compensation exceeded $100,000 for our fiscal year ended
December 31, 2003 (the "Named Executives").



Long-Term
Annual Compensation Compensation
----------------------------------------- ------------
Awards
------------
Other Annual Securities
Compensation Underlying All Other
Name and Principal Position Year Salary Bonus (1) Options (2) Compensation
- --------------------------- ---- --------- --------- ------------ ------------ ------------

Robert J. Laikin 2003 $ 600,000 $ 600,000 $ 6,000 -- $ 420
Chairman of the Board and 2002 450,000 225 000 5,500 298,927 --
Chief Executive Officer 2001 450,000 -- 88,550 44,996 --

J. Mark Howell 2003 $ 400,000 $ 300,000 $ 3,000 -- $ 378
President 2002 325,000 162,500 5,500 177,855 537
2001 325,000 -- 76,050 35,353 528

Frank Terence (3) 2003 $ 350,000 $ 262,500 $ 3,500 -- $ 420
Executive Vice President, Chief 2002 181,278 97,994 182,578(5) 241,070 400
Financial Officer and Treasurer 2001 -- -- -- -- --

Steven E. Fivel 2003 $ 325,000 $ 243,750 $ 5,188 -- $ 420
Executive Vice President, General 2002 275,000 137,500 5,500 138,213 597
Counsel and Secretary 2001 225,000 -- 36,300 24,103 528

Lisa M Kelley (4) 2003 $ 100,000 $ 75,000 $ 11,287(6) 22,500 $ 378
Senior Vice President, Chief 2002 -- -- -- -- --
Accounting Officer and Controller 2001 -- -- -- -- --



(1) Except as otherwise noted below, represents our matching contributions
to the respective employees 401(k) accounts and includes immaterial
refunds of less than $5,000 per year from the 401(k) Plan paid in 2004,
2003 and 2002, relating to ERISA compliance testing for the years 2003,
2002 and 2001. Also includes payments received by the executive
officers named above pursuant to the offer to exchange certain stock
options that we made to our employees and directors during 2001.

(2) All option amounts and exercise prices have been adjusted to give
retroactive effect to a one for seven reverse split of our Common Stock
effected in June 2002 and the three for two stock splits of our Common
Stock effected in August and October of 2003.

(3) Mr. Terence joined the Company in April 2002.

(4) Ms. Kelley joined the Company in July 2003.

(5) Represents amounts paid for Mr. Terence's moving and relocation costs
during 2002.

(6) Represents amounts paid for Ms. Kelley's moving and relocation costs
during 2003.


33


OPTION GRANTS IN LAST FISCAL YEAR

The following table provides information with respect to individual
stock options granted during fiscal 2003:



POTENTIAL REALIZABLE VALUE
% OF TOTAL AT ASSUMED ANNUAL RATES
OPTIONS OF STOCK PRICE
SHARES GRANTED TO APPRECIATION FOR OPTION
UNDERLYING EMPLOYEES EXERCISE TERM ($) (2)
OPTIONS IN FISCAL PRICE EXPIRATION --------------------------
NAME GRANTED (1) YEAR ($/SH) DATE 5% 10%
---- ----------- ---------- -------- ------------ -------- ---------

Lisa M. Kelley............ 22,500 22% $5.367 July 1, 2008 $ 33,363 $ 73,724


(1) The options were granted under our 1994 Stock Option Plan. The options
are exercisable as to one-third of the shares covered thereby on the
first, second and third anniversaries of the date of grant.

(2) The potential realizable value columns of the table illustrate values
that might be realized upon exercise of the options immediately prior
to their expiration, assuming our Common Stock appreciates at the
compounded rates specified over the term of the options. These numbers
do not take into account provisions of options providing for
termination of the option following termination of employment or
nontransferability of the options and do not make any provision for
taxes associated with exercise. Because actual gains will depend upon,
among other things, future performance of the Common Stock, there can
be no assurance that the amounts reflected in this table will be
achieved.

AGGREGATED OPTION EXERCISES AND FISCAL YEAR-END OPTION VALUES

The following table sets forth information concerning each exercise of
stock options by each of the Named Executives during the fiscal year ended
December 31, 2003 and the value of unexercised stock options held by the Named
Executives as of December 31, 2003:



NUMBER OF SECURITIES VALUE OF UNEXERCISED
UNDERLYING UNEXERCISED IN-THE-MONEY OPTIONS AT
SHARES OPTIONS AT DECEMBER 31, 2003 DECEMBER 31, 2003 (1)
ACQUIRED ON VALUE ------------------------------- -----------------------------
NAME EXERCISE REALIZED EXERCISABLE UNEXERCISABLE EXERCISABLE UNEXERCISABLE
- ---- ----------- ---------- ----------- ------------- ----------- -------------

Robert J. Laikin......... 193,929 $2,437,137 -- 214,278 $ -- $ 2,796,951
J. Mark Howell........... 340,531 2,102,735 23,571 130,352 122,498 1,693,630
Frank Terence............ 80,358 1,422,480 -- 160,712 -- 2,308,765
Steven E. Fivel.......... 84,640 1,094,600 20,088 100,176 -- 1,293,139
Lisa M. Kelley........... -- -- -- 22,500 -- 267,368


(1) Year-end values for unexercised in-the-money options represent the
positive spread between the exercise price of such options and the
year-end market value of the Common Stock.


34


DIRECTOR COMPENSATION

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003, non-employee directors
received annual cash compensation of $50,000 for services rendered in their
capacity as Board members. In addition, the lead independent director, the
Corporate Governance and Nominating Committee chairperson and Audit Committee
chairperson received $50,000, $10,000 and $10,000 for services rendered in those
roles. Members of the Audit Committee received annual payments of $10,000, for
services rendered in their capacity as committee members.

In 2003 we adopted and shareholders approved an Independent Director
Stock Compensation Plan (the "Director Stock Compensation Plan") pursuant to
which 900,000 shares of Common Stock are reserved for issuance to non-employee
directors. Pursuant to Director Stock Compensation Plan, subject to the
satisfaction of certain conditions, 30% of our Independent Director's annual
board compensation (but not committee compensation) will be paid in the form
shares of our restricted Common Stock. No shares were issued under the Director
Stock Compensation Plan in 2003.

We have adopted a Non-Employee Director Stock Option Plan (the
"Director Plan") pursuant to which 301,338 shares of Common Stock are reserved
for issuance to non-employee directors, of which 113,308 are available for grant
as of December 31, 2003. The Director Plan provides that eligible directors
automatically receive a grant of options to purchase 2,000 shares of Common
Stock upon first becoming a director and, thereafter, an annual grant, in
January of each year, of options to purchase 571 shares. Effective as of
December 31, 2002, the Board determined to suspend all future grants of options
under the Director Plan. All of the options that were granted under the Director
Plan were granted at fair market value on the date of grant and are exercisable
as to all of the shares covered thereby commencing one year from the date of
grant.

EMPLOYMENT AND SEVERANCE AGREEMENTS

We have entered into five-year "evergreen" employment agreements with
each of Messrs. Laikin and Howell, which are automatically renewable for
successive one-year periods and provide for an annual base compensation of
$670,000 and $410,000 respectively, and such bonuses as the Board of Directors
may from time to time determine. If we provide the employee with notice that we
desire to terminate the agreement or terminate the agreement without cause,
there is a final five-year term commencing on the date of such notice. The
employment agreements provide for employment on a full-time basis and contain a
provision that the employee will not compete or engage in a business competitive
with our business during the term of the employment agreement and for a period
of two years thereafter. The employment agreements also provide that if the
employee's employment is terminated by the employee, without Good Reason, as
defined, within 12 months after a "change of control," or if prior to and not as
a result of a change of control, the employee's employment is terminated either
by the employee for Good Reason or by us other than for disability or Cause, as
defined, the employee will be entitled to receive severance pay equal to the
highest of (a) $2,250,000 for Mr. Laikin and $1,625,000 for Mr. Howell or (b)
five times the total compensation (including salary, bonus and the value of all
perquisites) received from us during the twelve months prior to the date of
termination. If after or as a result of a change of control, the employee's
employment is terminated either by the employee for Good Reason or by us other
than for disability or Cause, the employee will be


35


entitled to receive severance pay equal to ten times the total compensation
(including salary, bonus, the value of all perquisites and the value of all
stock options granted to the employee) received from us during the twelve months
prior to the date of termination. In addition, (a) upon the occurrence of a
change of control, (b) if in breach of the agreement, we terminate the
employee's employment other than for disability or Cause, or (c) if the employee
terminates his employment for Good Reason at any time, the vesting of all
options granted to the employee will be accelerated so that the options become
immediately exercisable. For purposes of such agreements, a "change of control"
shall be deemed to occur, unless previously consented to in writing by the
respective employee, upon (i) individuals who constituted our then current Board
of Directors ceasing to constitute a majority of the Board of Directors, (ii)
subject to certain specified exceptions, the acquisition of beneficial ownership
of 15% or more of our voting securities by any person or entity not affiliated
with the respective employee or us, (iii) the commencement of a proxy contest
against management for the election of a majority of our Board of Directors if
the group conducting the proxy contest owns, has or gains the power to vote at
least 15% of our voting securities, (iv) the consummation under certain
conditions by us of a reorganization, merger or consolidation or sale of all or
substantially all of our assets to any person or entity not affiliated with the
respective employee or us, or (v) our complete liquidation or dissolution.

In addition, we have entered into a three-year "evergreen" employment
agreement with Mr. Fivel, which is automatically renewable for successive
one-year periods and provides for an annual base compensation of $335,000, and
such bonuses as the Board of Directors may from time to time determine. If we
provide the employee with notice that we desire to terminate the agreement
without cause, there is a final three-year term commencing on the date of such
notice. The agreement provides otherwise for substantially the same terms as the
employment agreements described above, except that if the employee's employment
is terminated by the employee, without Good Reason, as defined, within 12 months
after a "change of control," or if prior to and not as a result of a change of
control, the employee's employment is terminated either by the employee for Good
Reason or by us other than for disability or Cause, as defined, the employee
will be entitled to receive the highest of (a) $825,000 or (b) three times the
total compensation (including salary, bonus and the value of all perquisites )
received from us during the twelve months prior to the date of termination. If
after or as a result of a change of control, the employee's employment is
terminated either by the employee for Good Reason or by us other than for
disability or Cause, the employee will be entitled to receive severance pay
equal to six times the compensation (including, salary, bonus, and the value of
all perquisites and the value of all stock options granted to the employee)
received or earned from us during the twelve months prior to the date of
termination. In addition, (a) upon the occurrence of a change of control, (b) if
in breach of the agreement, we terminate the employee's employment other than
for disability or Cause, or (c) if the employee terminates his employment for
Good Reason at any time, the vesting of all options granted to the employee will
be accelerated so that the options become immediately exercisable.

We have also entered into a three-year "evergreen" employment agreement
with Mr. Terence on April 22, 2002, which is automatically renewable for
successive one-year periods and provides for an annual base compensation of
$410,000 and such bonuses as the Board of Directors may from time to time
determine. The employment agreement provides for employment on a full-time basis
and contains a provision that the employee will not compete or engage in a
business competitive with our business during the term of the employment
agreement and for a period of two years thereafter. The employment agreement
also provides that if the employee's employment is terminated by the employee,
without


36


Good Reason, as defined, within 12 months after a "change of control," or if
prior to and not as a result of a change of control, the employee's employment
is terminated either by the employee for Good Reason or by us other than for
disability or Cause, as defined, the employee will be entitled to receive
severance pay equal to three times the total compensation (including salary,
bonus and the value of all perquisites) received from us during the twelve
months prior to the date of termination. For purposes of such agreement, a
"change of control" shall be deemed to occur, unless previously consented to in
writing by the employee, upon (i) individuals who constituted our then current
Board of Directors ceasing to constitute a majority of the Board of Directors,
(ii) subject to certain specified exceptions, the acquisition of beneficial
ownership of 15% or more of our voting securities by any person or entity not
affiliated with the respective employee or us, (iii) the commencement of a proxy
contest against management for the election of a majority of our Board of
Directors if the group conducting the proxy contest owns, has or gains the power
to vote at least 15% of our voting securities, (iv) the consummation under
certain conditions by us of a reorganization, merger or consolidation or sale of
all or substantially all of our assets to any person or entity not affiliated
with the respective employee or us, or (v) our complete liquidation or
dissolution. In addition, (a) upon the occurrence of a change of control, (b) if
in breach of the agreement, we terminate the employee's employment other than
for disability or Cause, or (c) if the employee terminates his employment for
Good Reason at any time, the vesting of all options granted to the employee will
be accelerated so that the options become immediately exercisable.

We have also entered into a one-year "evergreen" employment agreement
with Ms. Kelley on June 9, 2003, which is automatically renewable for successive
one-year periods and provides for an annual base compensation of $200,000,
subject to any increase at the Company's discretion. She is also entitled to
such other discretionary cash bonuses and other compensation as the Company may
from time to time determine, provided that any discretionary bonus cannot exceed
50% of her base compensation. The employment agreement provides for employment
on a full-time basis and contains a provision that the employee will not compete
or engage in a business competitive with our business during the term of the
employment agreement and for a period of one year thereafter. The employment
agreement also allows the employee to terminate the agreement upon at least
thirty (30) days prior written notice and provides that if the employee's
employment is terminated by the employer other than due to death, disability or
for Cause, as defined, the employee shall be entitled to receive severance pay
equal to 12 months of her annual base salary, any earned but unpaid bonus and
reimbursement of certain business expenses. Moreover, upon a "change of
control," if the employee's employment is terminated by us other than for death,
disability or Cause, as defined, the employee will be entitled to an
acceleration of the vesting of any unvested stock options held by her, which
shall then remain exercisable for not less than 180 days. For purposes of such
agreement, a "change of control" shall be deemed to occur, unless previously
consented to in writing by the employee, upon (i) individuals who constituted
our then current Board of Directors ceasing to constitute a majority of the
Board of Directors, (ii) subject to certain specified exceptions, the
acquisition of beneficial ownership of 15% or more of our voting securities by
any person or entity not affiliated with the respective employee or us, (iii)
the commencement of a proxy contest against management for the election of a
majority of our Board of Directors if the group conducting the proxy contest
owns, has or gains the power to vote at least 15% of our voting securities, (iv)
the consummation under certain conditions by us of a reorganization, merger or
consolidation or sale of all or substantially all of our assets to any person or
entity not affiliated with the employee or us, or (v) our complete liquidation
or dissolution.


37


In connection with the termination of the employment of our former
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, Phillip Bounsall, we
previously entered into a separation and general release agreement with Mr.
Bounsall pursuant to which we paid Mr. Bounsall a severance payment in the
aggregate amount of $1 million of which $500,000 was paid to Mr. Bounsall on the
date of execution of the severance agreement and the balance of $500,000 was
placed in escrow during 2002 and released to him in January of 2003. In
addition, pursuant to the separation and general release agreement with Mr.
Bounsall, the vesting of certain options to purchase our Common Stock was
accelerated. All of the options that were accelerated expire on April 22, 2004.

COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER PARTICIPATION

We have a Compensation and Human Resources Committee of the Board of
Directors comprised of three Independent Directors (as defined in our Corporate
Governance Principles and NASDAQ Rules) and currently consisting of Mr. Stead
(Chairperson), Mr. Simon and Ms. Hermann. Decisions as to executive compensation
are currently made by the Compensation and Human Resources Committee. During
2002, prior to the adoption of our Compensation and Human Resources Committee
Charter, executive compensation was determined by the Board of Directors,
primarily upon the recommendation of our prior Compensation Committee. The Board
of Directors, which includes Messrs. Laikin and Howell, has not modified or
rejected any recommendations of the Compensation Committee as to the
compensation of our executive officers. During the fiscal year ended December
31, 2003, none of our executive officers have served on the board of directors
or the compensation committee of any other entity whose officers serves on our
Board of Directors or our Compensation and Human Resources Committee.


38

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT.

The following table sets forth certain information regarding the
beneficial ownership of the Common Stock as of February 27, 2004, based on
information obtained from the persons named below, (i) by each person known by
us to own beneficially more than five percent of our Common Stock, (ii) by each
of the Named Executives, (iii) by each of our directors, and (iv) by all of our
executive officers and directors as a group:


AMOUNT AND
NATURE OF PERCENTAGE OF
BENEFICIAL OUTSTANDING
NAME AND ADDRESS OF BENEFICIAL OWNER (1) OWNERSHIP (2) SHARES OWNED
- ---------------------------------------- ------------- -------------

Batterymarch Financial Management, Inc. (3) 1,638,263 8.5
Timothy S. Durham (4)................................................ 1,094,290 5.6
Robert J. Laikin (5)................................................. 139,637 *
J. Mark Howell (6)................................................... 73,875 *
Frank Terence (7).................................................... 48,213 *
Steven E. Fivel (8).................................................. 39,603 *
Jerre L. Stead (9)................................................... 32,532 *
Richard W. Roedel (10)............................................... 23,500 *
Robert F. Wagner (11)................................................ 9,220 *
Stephen H. Simon (12)................................................ 6,459 *
Todd H. Stuart (13).................................................. 5,570 *
Catherine M. Daily (14).............................................. 5,000 *
Marisa K. Pratt (15)................................................. 31 *
Eliza Hermann ....................................................... - *
Lisa M. Kelley (16).................................................. - *
V. William Hunt ..................................................... - *
All executive officers and directors
as a group (fourteen persons) (17)................................... 383,640 2.0

- ----------------------
* Less than 1%.


39

(1) The address for each of such individuals, unless specified otherwise in
a subsequent footnote, is in care of Brightpoint, Inc., 501 Airtech
Parkway, Plainfield, Indiana 46168.

(2) A person is deemed to be the beneficial owner of securities that can be
acquired by such person within 60 days from February 27, 2004 upon the
exercise of options. Each beneficial owner's percentage ownership is
determined by assuming that options or warrants that are held by such
person (but not those held by any other person) and which are
exercisable within 60 days of February 27, 2004 have been exercised.
Unless otherwise indicated, we believe that all persons named in the
table have sole voting and investment power with respect to all shares
of Common Stock beneficially owned by them.

(3) Based solely on a Schedule 13G filed with the United States Securities
and Exchange Commission by Batterymarch Financial Management, Inc. The
address of Batterymarch Financial Management, Inc. is 200 Clarendon
Street, Boston, MA 02116.

(4) Based solely on a joint Schedule 13D filed with the United States
Securities and Exchange Commission by Timothy S. Durham, Diamond
Investments, LLC, Henri B. Najem, Jr., Shelley Najem, Jeffrey Osler,
Neil Lucas, James F. Cochran, Jonathon B. Swain, Dr. Charles Durham,
Mitza Durham and Shannon Frantz. The address of Mr. Durham is 111
Monument Circle, Suite 4800, Indianapolis, Indiana 46204.

(5) Includes 39,636 shares underlying options, which are exercisable within
60 days of February 27, 2004. Includes 100,000 shares owned by Mr.
Laikin. Includes 1 share allocated from the Brightpoint, Inc. 1999
Employee Stock Purchase Plan ("ESPP"). Does not include options to
purchase 274,642 shares.

(6) Includes 57,138 shares underlying options, which are exercisable within
60 days of February 27, 2004. Includes 16,498 shares owned by J. Mark
Howell and 239 shares allocated from the 401(k). Does not include
options to purchase 146,785 shares.

(7) Includes 32,142 shares underlying options, which are exercisable within
60 days of February 27, 2004. Includes 8,037 shares owned by Mr.
Terence and 8,034 shares held by the Frank Terence and Katrina Marie
Terence Trust of October 31, 2001. Mr. Terence and his spouse are
trustees of this trust, which is for the benefit of his minor child.
Does not include options to purchase 178,570 shares.

(8) Includes 36,693 shares underlying options, which are exercisable within
60 days of February 27, 2004. Includes 2,569 shares owned by Mr. Fivel.
Includes 217 shares allocated from the ESPP and 124 shares allocated
from the 401(k). Does not include options to purchase 133,571 shares.

(9) Includes (i) 29,250 shares beneficially owned by Mr. Stead, which
shares are owned of record by JMJS Group LLP, and (ii) 3,282 shares
underlying options, which are exercisable within 60 days of February
27, 2004. Does not include options to purchase 357 shares.

(10) Includes 22,500 shares underlying options, which are exercisable within
60 days of February 27, 2004. Includes 1,000 shares owned by Mr.
Roedel.

(11) Includes 1,142 shares underlying options, which are exercisable within
60 days of February 27, 2004. Includes (i) 8,000 shares held by Robert
F. Wagner and Patricia D. Wagner and (ii) 78 shares held in a joint
account by Mr. Wagner and his emancipated son, of which shares Mr.
Wagner disclaims beneficial ownership. Does not include options to
purchase 1,142 shares.

(12) Includes (i) 1,607 shares owned by Mr. Simon and (ii) 4,852 shares
underlying options, which are exercisable within 60 days of February
27, 2004. Does not include options to purchase 1,142 shares.

(13) Includes 1,142 shares underlying options, which are exercisable within
60 days of February 27, 2004. Includes (i) 4,428 shares owned by Mr.
Stuart. Does not include options to purchase 1,142 shares.

(14) Includes 5,000 shares owned by Ms. Daily.

(15) Represents 31 shares owned by Ms. Pratt.

(16) Does not include options to purchase 42,500 shares.

(17) Includes an aggregate of 198,527 shares underlying options, which are
exercisable within 60 days of February 27, 2004, including those listed
in notes (5) through (16), above. Does not include options to purchase
an aggregate of 779,851 shares.



40


EQUITY COMPENSATION PLANS



Number of securities
remaining available for
Number of securities to Weighted-average issuance under equity
be issued upon exercise exercise price of compensation plans,
of outstanding options outstanding options excluding securities
and rights and rights reflected in column (a)
Plan Category (a) (b) (c)
------------- ----------------------- ------------------- ------------------------

Independent Director Stock Compensation
Plan 900,000

Equity compensation plans approved by
security holders: (1994 Stock Option Plan
and Non-Employee Director Stock Option
Plan) 1,043,762 $7.76 402,152

Equity compensation plans not approved by
security holders (1): (1996 Stock Option
Plan) 467,149 $5.32 283,511
--------- ----- ---------
Total 1,510,911 $7.00 1,585,663
========= ===== =========


(1) Represents the aggregate number of shares of common stock issuable upon
exercise of arrangements with option holders granted under our 1996
Stock Option Plan. These options are 5 to 10 years in duration, expire
at various dates between April 22, 2004 and November 14, 2012, contain
anti-dilution provisions providing for adjustments of the exercise
price under certain circumstances and have termination provisions
similar to options granted under stockholder approved plans. See Note
14 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for a description of the
1996 Stock Option Plan.

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS.

We utilize the services of a third party for the purchase of corporate
gifts, promotional items and standard personalized stationery. Mrs. Judy Laikin,
the mother of Robert J. Laikin, our Chief Executive Officer, was the owner of
this third party until June 1, 2000 and is an independent consultant to this
third party. We purchased approximately $63,321 and $91,382 of services and
products from this third party during 2003 and 2002. We believe that these
purchases were made on terms no less favorable to us than we could have obtained
from an unrelated party.

During the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003 we paid to an insurance
brokerage firm, for which the father of Robert J. Laikin acts as an independent
insurance broker, $225,415 in service fees and certain insurance premiums, which
premiums were forwarded to our respective insurance carriers.

The Company's Certificate of Incorporation and By-laws provide that it
indemnify its officers and directors to the extent permitted by law. In
connection therewith, the Company entered into indemnification agreements with
its executive officers and directors. In accordance with the terms of


41


these agreements the Company has reimbursed certain of its former executive
officers and intends to reimburse its officers and directors for their legal
fees and expenses incurred in connection with certain pending litigation and
regulatory matters. During 2003 and 2002, pursuant to their respective
indemnification agreements with Brightpoint, Inc., $26,606 and $93,280 in legal
fees was paid on behalf of Phillip Bounsall and $1,419 and $107,739 in legal
fees was paid on behalf of John Delaney.

ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES.

Audit Fees. The aggregate fees for professional services rendered by
Ernst & Young LLP for the audit of the Company's annual financial statements for
the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002, the review of the financial
statements included in the Company's Forms 10-Q for 2003 and 2002 and statutory
audits of foreign subsidiaries totaled $1,041,515 and $980,810, respectively.

Audit-Related Fees. The aggregate fees for assurance and related
services by Ernst & Young LLP that are related to the performance of the audit
or review of the Company's financial statements, for the years ended December
31, 2003 and 2002, and are not disclosed in the paragraph captions "Audit Fees"
above, were $53,820 and $27,500, respectively. The services performed by Ernst &
Young LLP in connection with these fees consisted of employee benefit plan
audits and internal controls consultation.

Tax Fees. The aggregate fees for professional services rendered by
Ernst & Young LLP for tax compliance, for the years ended December 31, 2003 and
2002, were $281,200 and $189,200, respectively. The aggregate fees billed by
Ernst & Young LLP for professional services rendered for tax advice and tax
planning, for the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002, were $215,050 and
$140,300, respectively. The services performed by Ernst & Young LLP in
connection with these advisory and planning fees consisted of the following: tax
audits and consultation regarding various tax issues.

All Other Fees. There were no fees for products and services by Ernst &
Young LLP, other than the services described in the paragraphs captioned "Audit
Fees", "Audit-Related Fees", and "Tax Fees" above for the years ended December
31, 2003 and 2002.

The Audit Committee has established its pre-approval policies and
procedures, pursuant to which the Audit Committee approved the foregoing audit
and permissible non-audit services provided by Ernst & Young LLP in 2003. The
Audit Committee's pre-approval policy is as follows: Consistent with the Audit
Committee's responsibility for engaging our independent auditors, all audit and
permitted non-audit services require pre-approval by the Audit Committee. All
requests or applications for services to be provided by the independent auditor
that do not require specific approval by the Audit Committee will be submitted
to the Chief Financial Officer and must include a detailed description of the
services to be rendered. The Chief Financial Officer will determine whether such
services are included within the list of services that have received the general
pre-approval of the Audit Committee. The Audit Committee will be informed on a
timely basis of any such services rendered by the independent auditor. Request
or applications to provide services that require specific approval by the Audit
Committee will be submitted to the Audit Committee by both the independent
auditor and the Chief Financial Officer, and must include a joint statement as
to whether, in their view, the request or application is consistent with the
SEC's rules on auditor independence. The Audit Committee has designated the Vice
President of Internal Audit to monitor the performance of all services provided
by the independent auditor and to


42


determine whether such services are in compliance with this policy. The Vice
President of Internal Audit will report to the Audit Committee on a periodic
basis on the results of its monitoring. The Vice President of Internal Audit and
management will immediately report to the chairman of the Audit Committee any
breach of this policy that comes to the attention of the Vice President of
Internal Audit or any member of management. The Audit Committee will also review
the internal auditor's annual internal audit plan to determine that the plan
provides for the monitoring of the independent auditor's services. Pursuant to
these procedures the Audit Committee approved the foregoing audit and
permissible non-audit services provided by Ernst & Young LLP in 2003.


43


PART IV

ITEM 15. FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES, EXHIBITS AND REPORTS ON
FORM 8-K.

(a)(1) The following financial statements and information are filed as a part
of our report commencing on page A-1:

Report of Independent Auditors

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended December
31, 2003, 2002 and 2001

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2003 and 2002

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity for the Years Ended
December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December
31, 2003, 2002 and 2001

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements


(a)(2) The following financial statement schedule for the year ended December
31, 2003, is submitted herewith:

Schedule II - Valuation and Qualifying Accounts

All other schedules are omitted because they are not applicable or the
required information is shown in the financial statements or notes
thereto.

(a)(3) Exhibits

EXHIBIT
NUMBER DESCRIPTION

2.1 Sale and Purchase Agreement between Brightpoint International
(Asia Pacific) PTE Ltd and Chinatron Group Holdings Limited
Dated October 1, 2001 (18)

2.1.1 Amendment dated January 18, 2002 to Sale and Purchase
Agreement between Brightpoint International (Asia Pacific) PTE
Ltd. and Chinatron Group Holding Limited dated October 1, 2001
(18)

2.2 Shareholders agreement between Brightpoint India Private
Limited, Brightpoint Holdings B.V., and Persequor Limited
dated November 1, 2003 (25)

2.3 Agreement for the Sale and Purchase of the entire issued share
capital of Brightpoint (Ireland) Limited dated February 19,
2004 (25)

3.1 Certificate of Incorporation of the Company, as amended
through 1992 (5)


44


EXHIBIT
NUMBER DESCRIPTION

3.1.2 Amendment to Certificate of Incorporation of the Company dated
June 26, 2002 (18)

3.2 Amended and Restated By-Laws of the Company (5)

3.3 Certificate of Merger of Brightpoint, Inc. into Wholesale
Cellular USA, Inc., effective September 15, 1995 (2)

4.1 Indenture between the Company and the Chase Manhattan Bank, as
Trustee (6)

10.1 1994 Stock Option Plan, as amended (11)*

10.2 1996 Stock Option Plan, as amended (14)*

10.3 Non-Employee Directors Stock Option Plan (1)

10.4 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (9)

10.5 Amended and Restated Employment Agreement between the Company
and Robert J. Laikin dated July 1, 1999 (10)*

10.6 Amended and Restated Employment Agreement between the Company
and J. Mark Howell dated July 1, 1999 (10)*

10.7 Amended and Restated Employment Agreement between the Company
and Phillip A. Bounsall dated July 1, 1999 (10)*

10.8 Amended and Restated Employment Agreement between the Company
and Steven E. Fivel dated July 1, 1999 (10)*

10.9 Rights Agreement, dated as of February 20, 1997, between the
Company and Continental Stock Transfer Trust Company, as
Rights Agent (3)

10.10 Lease Agreement between the Company and DP Operating
Partnership, L.P., dated as of December 23, 1998 (25)

10.11 Lease Agreement between the Company and Airtech Parkway
Associates, LLC, dated September 18, 1998 (7)

10.12 Form of Indemnification Agreement of certain officers and
directors (12)

10.13 Amendment Number 1 to the Rights Agreement (the "Agreement")
by and between Brightpoint, Inc. (the "Company") and
Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company, as Rights Agent,
appointing American Stock Transfer & Trust Company dated as of
January 4, 1999 (8)

10.14 Amendment dated January 1, 2001 to the Amended and Restated
Agreement between the Company and Robert J. Laikin dated July
1, 1999 (13)*



45


EXHIBIT
NUMBER DESCRIPTION

10.15 Amendment dated January 1, 2001 to the Amended and Restated
Employment Agreement between the Company and J. Mark Howell
dated July 1, 1999 (13)*

10.16 Amendment dated January 1, 2001 to the Amended and Restated
Employment Agreement between the Company and Steven E. Fivel
dated July 1, 1999 (13)*

10.17 Lease Agreement between the Company and Harbour Properties,
LLC, dated April 25, 2000 (13)

10.18 Amendment dated January 1, 2002 to the Amended and Restated
Employment Agreement between the Company and Steven E. Fivel
dated July 1, 1999 (17)*

10.19 Distributor Agreement dated October 29, 2001 between Nokia
Inc. and Brightpoint North America L.P. (17)**

10.20 Brightpoint, Inc. 401(k) Plan (2001 Restatement) (17)

10.21 Amendment to the Brightpoint, Inc. 401(k) Plan effective
January 1, 2001 (17)

10.22 Separation and General Release Agreement between the Company
and Phillip A. Bounsall (18)

10.23 Employment Agreement between the Company and Frank Terence
dated April 22, 2002 (18)*

10.24 Credit Agreement dated as of October 31, 2001 (as amended)
among Brightpoint North America, L.P., Wireless Fulfillment
Services LLC, the other credit parties signatory thereto, the
lenders signatory thereto from time to time and General
Electric Capital Corporation (15)

10.25 Amendment No. 2 dated September 27, 2002 to Credit Agreement
among Brightpoint North America, L.P., Wireless Fulfillment
Services, LLC, the other credit parties signatory thereto, the
lenders signatory thereto and General Electric Capital
Corporation (19)

10.26 Amendment No. 3 dated December 13, 2002 to Credit Agreement
among Brightpoint North America, L.P., Wireless Fulfillment
Services, LLC, the other credit parties signatory thereto, the
lenders signatory thereto and General Electric Capital
Corporation (20)

10.27 Amendment dated December 19, 2002 to distribution agreement
dated October 29, 2001 between Brightpoint North America L.P.
and Nokia Inc. (21)**


46


EXHIBIT
NUMBER DESCRIPTION

10.28 Amendment dated January 1, 2003 to Amended and Restated
Employment Agreement between the Company and Robert J. Laikin
dated July 1, 1999 (21)*

10.29 Amendment dated January 1, 2003 to Amended and Restated
Employment Agreement between the Company and J. Mark Howell
dated July 1, 1999 (21)*

10.30 Amendment dated January 1, 2003 to Amended and Restated
Employment Agreement between the Company and Steven E. Fivel
dated July 1, 1999 (21)*

10.31 Amendment dated January 1, 2003 to the Employment Agreement
between the Company and Frank Terence dated April 22, 2002
(21)*

10.32 Credit Agreement dated December 24, 2002 between Brightpoint
Australia Pty Limited, Advanced Portable Technologies Limited
and GE Commercial Finance (21)

10.33 Agreement dated June 6, 2002 between the Company and Chanin
Capital Partners (21)

10.34 Amendment dated July 8, 2002 to the Agreement between the
Company and Chanin Capital Partners dated June 6, 2002 (21)

10.35 Brightpoint, Inc. 401(k) Plan, effective October 1, 2002 (21)

10.36 Amendment No. 4 dated December 13, 2002 to Credit Agreement
among Brightpoint North America, L.P., Wireless Fulfillment
Services, LLC, the other credit parties signatory thereto, the
lenders signatory thereto and General Electric Capital
Corporation (22)

10.37 Amendment No. 5 dated December 13, 2002 to Credit Agreement
among Brightpoint North America, L.P., Wireless Fulfillment
Services, LLC, the other credit parties signatory thereto, the
lenders signatory thereto and General Electric Capital
Corporation (23)

10.38 Indemnification Agreement between Brightpoint and Mr. Frank
Terence dated July 29, 2003 (24)

10.39 Amendment No. 6 dated November 3, 2003 to Credit Agreement
among Brightpoint North America, L.P., Wireless Fulfillment
Services, LLC, the other credit parties signatory thereto, the
lenders signatory thereto and General Electric Capital
Corporation (25)

10.40 Credit Agreement dated as of November 28, 2003 between
Brightpoint New Zealand Limited and GE Capital (NZ) Limited
(25)


47


EXHIBIT
NUMBER DESCRIPTION

10.41 Amendment No. 2 dated December 31, 2003 to Distributor
Agreement between Brightpoint North America, L.P. and Nokia,
Inc.***

10.42 Amendment dated January 1, 2004 to Amended and Restated
Employment Agreement between the Company and Robert J. Laikin
dated July 1, 1999 (25)*

10.43 Amendment dated January 1, 2004 to Amended and Restated
Employment Agreement between the Company and J. Mark Howell
dated July 1, 1999 (25)*

10.44 Amendment dated January 1, 2004 to Amended and Restated
Employment Agreement between the Company and Frank Terence
dated April 22, 2002 (25)*

10.45 Amendment dated January 1, 2004 to Amended and Restated
Employment Agreement between the Company and Steven E. Fivel
dated July 1, 1999 (25)*

10.46 Indemnification Agreement between Brightpoint and Mr. V.
William Hunt dated February 11, 2004 (25)

10.47 Employment Agreement between the Company and Lisa M. Kelley
dated June 9, 2003 (25)*

21 Subsidiaries (25)

23 Consent of Independent Auditors (16)

31.1 Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Rule
13a-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, implementing
Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (25)

31.2 Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Rule
13a-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, implementing
Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (25)

32.1 Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C.
Section 1350, As Adopted Pursuant Section 906 of the
Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (25)

32.2 Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C.
Section 1350, As Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the
Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (25)

99.1 Cautionary Statements (25)


48


Footnotes

(1) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Registration Statement (33-75148) effective
April 7, 1994.

(2) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 1994.

(3) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K, dated March 28,
1997.

(4) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter
ended March 31, 1997.

(5) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-3 (333-29533)
effective August 6, 1997.

(6) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the exhibit filed with the Company's Current Report on Form
8-K dated April 1, 1998 for the event dated March 5, 1998.

(7) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter
ended September 30, 1998.

(8) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31,
1998.

(9) Incorporated by reference to Appendix B filed with the
Company's Proxy Statement dated April 15, 1999 relating to its
Annual Stockholders meeting held May 18, 1999.

(10) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Quarterly report on Form 10-Q for the quarter
ended June 30, 1999.

(11) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-8 (333-87863)
dated September 27, 1999.

(12) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1999.

(13) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
Form 10-K/A, Amendment No. 1 to the Company's Form 10-K for
the year ended December 31, 2000.

(14) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Tender Offer Statement on Schedule TO dated
August 31, 2001.

(15) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K for the event dated
November 1, 2001.

(16) Filed as page F-1 of this report on Form 10-K.

(17) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 2001.

(18) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter
ended June 30, 2002.

(19) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K for the event dated
September 27, 2002.

(20) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K for the event dated
December 13, 2002.



49


Footnotes to the Exhibits (continued)

(21) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 2002

(22) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter
ended March 31, 2003

(23) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter
ended June 30, 2003

(24) Incorporated by reference to the applicable exhibit filed with
the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter
ended September 30, 2003

(25) Filed herewith

* Denotes management compensation plan or arrangement.

** Portions of this document have been omitted and filed
separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant
to a request for confidential treatment, which was granted under
Rule 24b-2 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

*** Portions of this document have been omitted and filed
separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant
to a request for confidential treatment under Rule 24b-2 of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934.


(b) Reports on Form 8-K:

None


50


SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this amended report to be
signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

BRIGHTPOINT, INC.

Date: March 9, 2004 /s/Robert J. Laikin
-------------------------------------------------
By: Robert J. Laikin
Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934,
this amended report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of
the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated:



SIGNATURE TITLE DATE
- --------- ----- ----

/s/ Robert J. Laikin Chairman of the Board March 9, 2004
- --------------------------------- Chief Executive Officer and Director (Principal Executive Officer)
Robert J. Laikin

/s/ J. Mark Howell President and March 9, 2004
- --------------------------------- Director
J. Mark Howell

/s/ Frank Terence Executive Vice President, Chief Financial March 9, 2004
- --------------------------------- Officer and Treasurer (Principal Financial Officer)
Frank Terence

/s/ Lisa M. Kelley Senior Vice President and Corporate Controller March 9, 2004
- --------------------------------- (Principal Accounting Officer)
Lisa M. Kelley

/s/ Catherine M. Daily Director March 9, 2004
- ---------------------------------
Catherine M. Daily

/s/ Eliza Hermann Director March 9, 2004
- ---------------------------------
Eliza Hermann

/s/ V. William Hunt Director March 9, 2004
- ---------------------------------
V. William Hunt

/s/ Marisa E. Pratt Director March 9, 2004
- ---------------------------------
Marisa E. Pratt

/s/ Richard W. Roedel Director March 9, 2004
- ---------------------------------
Richard W. Roedel

/s/ Stephen H. Simon Director March 9, 2004
- ---------------------------------
Stephen H. Simon

/s/ Jerre L. Stead Director March 9, 2004
- ---------------------------------
Jerre L. Stead

/s/ Todd H. Stuart Director March 9, 2004
- ---------------------------------
Todd H. Stuart

/s/ Robert F. Wagner Director March 9, 2004
- ---------------------------------
Robert F. Wagner



51


FINANCIAL INFORMATION APPENDIX A

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------



Report of Independent Auditors...............................................A-2
Management's Responsibility for Financial Statements.........................A-3
Consolidated Statements of Operations........................................A-4
Consolidated Balance Sheets..................................................A-5
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows........................................A-6
Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity..............................A-7
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements...................................A-8
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations........................................A-44
Operating Segments...........................................................A-81
Future Operating Results.....................................................A-82
Financial Market Risk Management.............................................A-83
Other Information............................................................A-84



A-1


REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders
Brightpoint, Inc.

We have audited the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets of Brightpoint,
Inc. as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, and the related Consolidated Statements
of Operations, Stockholders' Equity and Cash Flows for each of the three years
in the period ended December 31, 2003. Our audits also include the financial
statement schedule listed in Item 15(a)(2). These financial statements and
schedule are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility
is to express an opinion on these financial statements and schedule based on our
audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted
in the United States. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit
to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free
of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence
supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit
also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates
made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement
presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our
opinion.

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in
all material respects, the consolidated financial position of Brightpoint, Inc.
at December 31, 2003 and 2002, and the consolidated results of its operations
and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31,
2003, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United
States. Also, in our opinion, the related financial statement schedule, when
considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole,
presents fairly in all material respects the financial information set forth
therein.

As discussed in Notes 1 and 7 to the consolidated financial statements, the
Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 142 "Goodwill
and Other Intangible Assets" and No. 144 "Accounting for the Impairment or
Disposal of Long-Lived Assets," respectively, on January 1, 2002. As discussed
in Note 1, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No.
145 "Rescission of FASB Statements No. 4, 44 and 64, Amendment of FASB Statement
No. 13 and Technical Corrections", on January 1, 2003.

/S/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP

Indianapolis, Indiana
January 23, 2004, except for Note 18,
as to which the date is February 19, 2004


A-2


MANAGEMENT'S RESPONSIBILITY FOR FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The management of Brightpoint, Inc. is responsible for the preparation and
integrity of the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements and all related
information appearing in this Annual Report. The Company maintains accounting
and internal control systems which are intended to provide reasonable assurance
that assets are safeguarded against loss from unauthorized use or disposition,
transactions are executed in accordance with management's authorization and
accounting records are reliable for preparing financial statements in accordance
with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States.

The financial statements for each of the years covered in this Annual Report
have been audited by independent auditors who have provided an independent
assessment as to the fairness of the financial statements.

The Board of Directors has appointed an Audit Committee whose current four
members are not employees of the Company. The Board of Directors has also
adopted a written charter that establishes the roles and responsibilities of the
Audit Committee. Pursuant to its charter, the Audit Committee meets with certain
members of management, internal audit and the independent auditors to review the
results of their work and satisfy itself that their responsibilities are being
properly discharged. The independent auditors have full and free access to the
Audit Committee and have discussions with the Audit Committee regarding
appropriate matters, with and without management present.



/s/ ROBERT J. LAIKIN /s/ FRANK TERENCE /s/ LISA M. KELLEY
Robert J. Laikin Frank Terence Lisa M. Kelley
Chairman of the Board and Executive Vice President, Senior Vice President and
Chief Executive Officer Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer Chief Accounting Officer




A-3

BRIGHTPOINT, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(Amounts in thousands, except per share data)



YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31
---------------------------------------------
2003 2002 2001
----------- ----------- -----------

Revenue
Distribution revenue $ 1,573,500 $ 1,089,534 $ 1,107,802
Integrated logistics services revenue 226,874 186,533 155,898
----------- ----------- -----------
Total revenue 1,800,374 1,276,067 1,263,700

Cost of revenue
Cost of distribution revenue 1,519,128 1,060,218 1,067,880
Cost of integrated logistics services revenue 181,023 143,855 122,045
----------- ----------- -----------
Total cost of revenue 1,700,151 1,204,073 1,189,925
----------- ----------- -----------

Gross profit 100,223 71,994 73,775

Selling, general and administrative expenses 73,867 71,247 66,396
Facility consolidation charge 5,461 -- 605
----------- ----------- -----------
Operating income from continuing operations 20,895 747 6,774

Interest expense 1,146 5,899 8,170
Impairment loss on long-term investment -- 8,305 --
Loss (gain) on debt extinguishment 365 (44,378) (7,167)
Other expenses 2,488 1,936 131
----------- ----------- -----------
Income from continuing operations before income taxes 16,896 28,985 5,640

Income tax expense 3,965 15,180 2,542
----------- ----------- -----------
Income from continuing operations before minority interest 12,931 13,805 3,098

Minority interest (24) -- --
----------- ----------- -----------

Income from continuing operations 12,955 13,805 3,098

Discontinued operations:
Loss from discontinued operations (698) (12,861) (22,098)
Loss on disposal of discontinued operations (528) (2,617) (34,301)
----------- ----------- -----------
Total discontinued operations (1,226) (15,478) (56,399)

Income (loss) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle 11,729 (1,673) (53,301)

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax -- (40,748) --
----------- ----------- -----------

Net income (loss) $ 11,729 $ (42,421) $ (53,301)
=========== =========== ===========

Basic per share:
Income from continuing operations $ 0.71 $ 0.77 $ 0.17
Discontinued operations (0.07) (0.86) (3.14)
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax -- (2.26) --
----------- ----------- -----------
Net income (loss) $ 0.64 $ (2.35) $ (2.97)
=========== =========== ===========

Diluted per share:
Income from continuing operations $ 0.68 $ 0.77 $ 0.17
Discontinued operations (0.06) (0.86) (3.14)
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax -- (2.26) --
----------- ----------- -----------
Net income (loss) $ 0.62 $ (2.35) $ (2.97)
=========== =========== ===========

Weighted average common shares outstanding:
Basic 18,170 17,996 17,940
=========== =========== ===========
Diluted 19,002 18,019 17,941
=========== =========== ===========


See accompanying notes.


A-4


BRIGHTPOINT, INC.
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(Amounts in thousands, except per share data)



DECEMBER 31
-------------------------
2003 2002
--------- ---------

ASSETS
Current assets:
Cash and cash equivalents $ 98,879 $ 43,798
Pledged cash 22,042 14,734
Accounts receivable (less allowance for doubtful
accounts of $7,683 in 2003 and $13,948 in 2002) 132,944 111,771
Inventories 108,665 73,472
Contract financing receivable 10,838 16,960
Other current assets 13,083 12,867
--------- ---------
Total current assets 386,451 273,602

Property and equipment, net 29,566 35,696
Goodwill and other intangibles, net 19,340 14,153
Other assets 9,333 12,851
--------- ---------

Total assets $ 444,690 $ 336,302
========= =========

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
Current liabilities:
Accounts payable $ 204,242 $ 129,621
Accrued expenses 60,960 48,816
Unfunded portion of contract financing receivable 15,697 22,102
Lines of credit 16,207 10,103
Convertible notes -- 12,017
--------- ---------
Total current liabilities 297,106 222,659
--------- ---------

COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

Minority interest -- --

Stockholders' equity:
Preferred stock, $0.01 par value: 1,000 shares
authorized; no shares issued or outstanding -- --
Common stock, $0.01 par value: 100,000 shares
authorized; 19,262 and 18,048 issued and
outstanding in 2003 and 2002, respectively 193 180
Additional paid-in capital 227,338 214,524
Retained earnings (deficit) (77,738) (89,467)
Accumulated other comprehensive loss (2,209) (11,594)
--------- ---------
Total stockholders' equity 147,584 113,643
--------- ---------

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity $ 444,690 $ 336,302
========= =========


See accompanying notes.


A-5


BRIGHTPOINT, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(Amounts in thousands)



YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31
------------------------------------
2003 2002 2001
-------- -------- --------

OPERATING ACTIVITIES
Net income (loss) $ 11,729 $(42,421) $(53,301)
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash
provided by operating activities:
Depreciation and amortization 12,733 12,431 12,039
Amortization of debt discount 33 3,709 5,182
Facility consolidation charge 5,461 -- 605
Restricted cash requirements (2,308) 1,923 (16,657)
Change in deferred taxes 2,010 12,852 (6,478)
Discontinued operations 1,226 15,478 56,399
Net cash used by discontinued operations (793) (8,517) (11,695)
Income tax benefits from exercise of stock options 445 -- --
Gain (loss) on debt extinguishment 365 (44,378) (7,167)
Minority interest 24 -- --
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of
tax -- 40,748 --
Impairment loss on long-term investment -- 8,305 --
Changes in operating assets and
liabilities, net of effects from acquisitions and divestitures:
Accounts receivable (4,306) 70,068 13,981
Inventories (27,575) 53,888 77,912
Other operating assets 806 17,450 4,307
Accounts payable and accrued expenses 55,677 (71,415) (24,488)
-------- -------- --------
Net cash provided by operating activities 55,527 70,121 50,639

INVESTING ACTIVITIES
Capital expenditures (6,057) (8,671) (27,442)
Purchase acquisitions, net of cash acquired (2,880) -- (7,963)
Cash effect of divestiture 1,328 (6,307) --
Proceeds from Mexico sale -- 2,758 --
Decrease (increase) in funded contract financing receivables 5,887 20,750 (5,199)
Decrease (increase) in other assets 154 169 (1,638)
-------- -------- --------
Net cash provided (used) by investing activities (1,568) 8,699 (42,242)

FINANCING ACTIVITIES
Net proceeds (payments) on credit facilities 2,761 (18,436) (18,934)
Restricted cash requirements (5,000) -- --
Repurchase of convertible notes (11,980) (75,015) (10,095)
Proceeds from common stock issuances under employee stock
option and purchase plans 12,383 173 259
-------- -------- --------
Net cash used by financing activities (1,836) (93,278) (28,770)

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents 2,958 (39) (1,050)
-------- -------- --------

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents 55,081 (14,497) (21,423)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year 43,798 58,295 79,718
-------- -------- --------
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year $ 98,879 $ 43,798 $ 58,295
======== ======== ========


See accompanying notes.


A-6


BRIGHTPOINT, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(Amounts in thousands)




Accumulated
Additional Retained Other Total
Common Paid-in Earnings Comprehensive Stockholders' Comprehensive
Stock Capital (Deficit) Income (Loss) Equity Income (Loss)
--------- ---------- --------- ------------- ------------- -------------

Balance at January 1, 2001 $ 180 $ 214,092 $ 6,255 $ (26,430) $ 194,097
2001 Activity:
Net loss -- -- (53,301) -- (53,301) $ (53,301)
Other comprehensive income (loss):
Currency translation of foreign
investments -- -- -- 9,097 9,097 9,097
Unrealized loss on derivatives, net
of income tax -- -- -- (140) (140) (140)
Common stock issued in connection
with employee stock option and
purchase plans and related income
tax benefit -- 260 -- -- 260
--------- --------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Balance at December 31, 2001 $ 180 $ 214,352 $ (47,046) $ (17,473) $ 150,013 $ (44,344)
=========

2002 Activity:
Net loss -- -- (42,421) -- (42,421) $ (42,421)
Other comprehensive income (loss):
Currency translation of foreign
investments -- -- -- 5,929 5,929 5,929
Unrealized loss on derivatives, net
of income tax -- -- -- (50) (50) (50)
Common stock issued in connection
with employee stock option and
purchase plans and related income
tax benefit -- 172 -- -- 172
--------- --------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Balance at December 31, 2002 $ 180 $ 214,524 $ (89,467) $ (11,594) $ 113,643 $ (36,542)
=========

2003 Activity:
Net income -- -- 11,729 -- 11,729 $ 11,729
Other comprehensive income (loss):
Currency translation of foreign
investments -- -- -- 9,385 9,385 9,385
Common stock issued in connection
with employee stock option and
purchase plans and related income
tax benefit 13 12,814 -- -- 12,827
--------- --------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 2003 $ 193 $ 227,338 $ (77,738) $ (2,209) $ 147,584 $ 21,114
========= ========= ========= ========= ========= =========


See accompanying notes.


A-7


NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

NATURE OF BUSINESS

Brightpoint, Inc. (the "Company") is one of the largest dedicated distributors
of wireless devices and accessories in the world, with operations centers and/or
sales offices in various countries including Australia, Colombia, France,
Germany, India, New Zealand, Norway, the Philippines, Sweden and the United
States. In addition, the Company provides integrated logistics services
including, procurement, inventory management, customized packaging, fulfillment,
activation management, prepaid and e-business solutions within the global
wireless industry. The Company's customers include wireless network operators,
resellers, retailers and wireless equipment manufacturers. The Company handles
wireless products from leading manufacturers such as Nokia, Motorola, Kyocera,
Audiovox, Sony Ericsson, Siemens, Samsung, Panasonic and PalmOne.

The Company is incorporated under the laws of the State of Indiana in August
1989 under the name Wholesale Cellular USA, Inc. and reincorporated under the
laws of the State of Delaware in March 1994. In September 1995, the Company
changed its name to Brightpoint, Inc.

PRINCIPLES OF CONSOLIDATION

The Consolidated Financial Statements include the accounts of the Company and
its subsidiaries, all of which are wholly-owned, with the exception of the
Brightpoint India Limited subsidiary that is 85% owned by the Company.
Significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in
consolidation. Certain amounts in the 2002 and 2001 Consolidated Financial
Statements have been reclassified to conform to the 2003 presentation.

USE OF ESTIMATES

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles
generally accepted in the United States requires management to make estimates
and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities,
disclosure of any contingent assets and liabilities at the financial statement
date and reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting period.
On an on-going basis, the Company reviews its estimates and assumptions. The
Company's estimates were based on its historical experience and various other
assumptions that the Company believes to be reasonable under the circumstances.
Actual results are likely to differ from those estimates under different
assumptions or conditions, but management does not believe such differences will
materially affect the Company's financial position or results of operations.

REVENUE RECOGNITION

The Company recognizes revenue in accordance with SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin
No. 101, "Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements" ("SAB 101") and SEC Staff
Accounting Bulletin No. 104, "Revenue Recognition" ("SAB 104"). Revenue is
recognized when the title and risk of loss have passed to the customer, there is
persuasive evidence of an arrangement, delivery has occurred or services have
been rendered, the sales price is fixed or determinable, and collectibility is
reasonably assured.


A-8


1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

REVENUE RECOGNITION (CONTINUED)

For distribution revenue, which is recorded using the gross method, the criteria
of SAB 101 and SAB 104 are generally met upon shipment to customers, including
title transfer, and, therefore, revenue is recognized at the time of shipment.
In some circumstances, the customer may take legal title and assume risk of loss
upon delivery and, therefore, revenue is recognized on the delivery date. In
certain countries, title is retained by the Company for collection purposes
only, which does not impact the timing of revenue recognition in accordance to
the provisions of SAB 101 and SAB 104. Sales are recorded net of discounts,
rebates, returns, and allowances. The Company does not have any material
post-shipment obligations (e.g. customer acceptance), warranties or other
arrangements. A portion of the Company's sales involves shipments of products
directly from its suppliers to its customers. In such circumstances, the Company
negotiates the price with the supplier and the customer, assumes responsibility
for the delivery of the product and, at times, takes the ownership risk while
the product is in transit, pays the supplier directly for the product shipped,
establishes payment terms and bears credit risk of collecting payment from its
customers. Furthermore, in these arrangements, the Company bears responsibility
for accepting returns of products from the customer. Under these arrangements,
the Company serves as the principal with the customer, as defined under Emerging
Issues Task Force Issue No. 99-19 ("EITF 99-19"), Reporting Revenue Gross as a
Principal versus Net as an Agent, and therefore recognizes the sale and cost of
sale of the product upon receiving notification from the supplier that the
product has shipped or in cases of FOB destination, CIP destination, or similar
terms, the Company recognizes the sales upon confirmation of delivery to the
customer at the named destination.

For integrated logistics service revenue, the criteria of SAB 101 and SAB 104
are met when the Company's integrated logistics services have been performed
and, therefore, revenue is recognized at that time. As a part of our integrated
logistics services the Company may, in certain circumstances, manage and
distribute wireless devices and prepaid recharge cards on behalf of various
wireless network operators and assumes little or no ownership risk for the
product, other than custodial risk of loss. Under these arrangements the Company
has an agency relationship in the transaction as defined by EITF 99-19 and
recognizes only the fee associated with serving as an agent. As part of the
integrated logistics services, the Company may provide contract financing
services to wireless network operators. In these arrangements, the service fee
is recorded net and is recognized when products have been shipped. In other
integrated logistics services arrangements, the Company receives activation
commissions for acquiring subscribers on behalf of wireless network operators
through its independent dealer agents or through Company-owned stores. In the
event activation occurs through an independent dealer/agent, a portion of the
commission is passed on to the dealer/agent. These arrangements may contain
provisions for additional residual commissions based on subscriber usage. These
agreements may also provide for the reduction or elimination of activation
commissions if subscribers deactivate service within stipulated periods. The
Company recognizes revenue for activation commissions upon activation of the
subscriber's service and residual commissions when earned. An allowance is
established for estimated wireless service deactivations as a reduction of
accounts receivable and revenues. In circumstances when the Company acts as the
obligor and determines the commission it will offer to independent
dealer/agents, the Company recognizes the full commission earned from the
wireless network operator using the gross method. In circumstances where the
Company is acting as an agent for wireless network operators as defined by EITF
99-19, the Company recognizes the revenue using the net method. Performance
penalty clauses may be included in certain contracts whereby the Company
provides for integrated logistics services within its Americas division. In
general, these penalties


A-9

1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

REVENUE RECOGNITION (CONTINUED)

are in the form of reduced per unit fees or a specific dollar amount. In the
event the Company has incurred performance penalties, revenues are reduced
accordingly within each calendar month.

VENDOR PROGRAMS

The Company has three major types of incentive arrangements with various
suppliers: price protection, volume incentive rebates, and marketing, training
and promotional funds. The Company follows Emerging Issues Task Force Issue No.
02-16, "Accounting by a Customer (Including a Reseller) for Certain
Consideration Received from a Vendor" and Emerging Issues Task Force No. 03-10,
"Application of Issue No. 02-16 by Resellers to Sales Incentives Offered to
Consumers by Manufacturers" in accounting for vendor programs. To the extent
that the Company receives excess funds from suppliers for reimbursement of its
costs, the Company recognizes the excess as a liability due to the supplier,
which is applied to future costs incurred on behalf of the supplier.

o Price protection: consideration is received from certain, but not all,
suppliers in the form of a credit memo based on market conditions as
determined by the supplier. The amount is determined based on the
difference between original purchase price from the supplier and
revised list price from the supplier. The term of the price protection
varies by supplier and product, but is typically less than one month
from original date of purchase. This amount is accrued as a reduction
of trade accounts payable until a credit memo is received and applied
as a debit to the outstanding accounts payable. This same amount is
either a reduction of inventory cost or is a reduction of cost of sales
for those wireless devices already sold.

o Volume incentive rebates: consideration is received from certain
suppliers when purchase or sell-through targets are attained or
exceeded within a specified time period. The amount of rebate earned in
any financial reporting period is accrued as a vendor receivable, which
is classified as a reduction of trade accounts payable. This same
amount is either a reduction of inventory cost or is a reduction of
cost of sales for those devices already sold. In certain markets, the
amount of the rebate is determined based on actual volumes purchased
for the incentive period to date at the established rebate percentage
regardless of volumes attained. In other markets, where the arrangement
has a tiered rate structure for increasing volumes, the rate of the
rebate is determined based on the actual volumes purchased plus
reasonable, predictable estimates of future volumes. In the event the
future volumes are not reasonably estimable, the Company records the
incentive at the conclusion of the rebate period or at the point in
time when the volumes are reasonably estimable. Upon expiration of the
rebate period an adjustment is recognized through inventory or cost of
sales for devices already sold if there is any variance between
estimated rebate receivable and actual rebate earned. To the extent
that the Company passes-through rebates to our customers, the amount is
recognized as a liability in the period that it is probable and
reasonably estimable.

Marketing, training and promotional funds: consideration is received from
certain suppliers for cooperative arrangements related to market development,
training and special promotions agreed upon in advance. The amount received is
generally in the form of a credit memo, which is applied to trade accounts
payable. The same amount is recorded as a current liability. Expenditures made
pursuant to the agreed upon activity reduces this liability. To the extent that
the Company incurs costs in excess of the established supplier fund, the Company
recognizes the amount as a selling expense.


A-10


1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS

All highly liquid investments with maturities of three months or less when
purchased are considered to be cash equivalents. Pledged cash represents cash
reserved as collateral for letters of credit issued by financial institutions on
behalf of the Company or its subsidiaries, as collateral on a short-term credit
facility in India, and as collateral for an accounts receivable sale facility in
France.

CONCENTRATIONS OF RISK

Financial instruments that potentially expose the Company to concentrations of
credit risk consist primarily of trade accounts receivable. These receivables
are generated from product sales and services provided to wireless network
operators, agents, resellers, dealers and retailers in the global wireless
industry and are dispersed throughout the world, including North America, South
America, Asia and the Pacific Rim and Europe. The Company performs periodic
credit evaluations of its customers and provides credit in the normal course of
business to a large number of its customers. However, consistent with industry
practice, the Company does not generally require collateral from its customers
to secure trade accounts receivable.

In 2003, Computech Overseas International, a customer of the Company's
Brightpoint Asia Limited operations, accounted for approximately 10% of our
total revenue and 19% of the Asia-Pacific division's revenue. At December 31,
2003, there were no amounts owed to the Company from Computech. In 2002,
Computech Overseas International accounted for approximately 12% of total
revenue and 30% of Asia-Pacific division's revenue. At December 31, 2002, there
were no amounts owed to the Company from Computech. In 2001, no customer
accounted for more than 10% of total revenue. The loss or a significant
reduction in business activities by our customers, including Computech Overseas
International, could have a material adverse affect on the Company's revenue and
results of operations.

The Company is primarily dependent upon wireless equipment manufacturers for its
supply of wireless voice and data equipment. Products sourced from the Company's
largest supplier accounted for approximately 79%, 69% and 72% of product
purchases in 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively. The Company is dependent on the
ability of its suppliers to provide an adequate supply of products on a timely
basis and on favorable pricing terms. The loss of certain principal suppliers or
a significant reduction in product availability from principal suppliers could
have a material adverse effect on the Company. The Company also relies on its
suppliers to provide trade credit facilities and favorable payment terms to
adequately fund its on-going operations and product purchases. In certain
circumstances, the Company has issued cash-secured letters of credit on behalf
of certain of our subsidiaries in support of their vendor credit facilities. The
payment terms received from the Company's suppliers is dependent on several
factors, including, but not limited to, the Company's payment history with the
supplier, the suppliers credit granting policies, contractual provisions, the
Company's overall credit rating as determined by various credit rating agencies,
the Company's recent operating results, financial position and cash flows and
the supplier's ability to obtain credit insurance on amounts that the Company
owes them. Adverse changes in any of these factors, certain of which may not be
wholly in the Company's control, could have a material adverse effect on the
Company's operations. The Company believes that its relationships with its
suppliers are satisfactory, however, it has periodically experienced inadequate
supply of certain models from certain wireless device manufacturers.


A-11


1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

ALLOWANCE FOR DOUBTFUL ACCOUNTS

The Company evaluates the collectibility of its accounts receivable. In
circumstances where the Company is aware of a specific customer's inability to
meet its financial obligations, the Company records a specific allowance against
amounts due to reduce the net recognized receivable to the amount the Company
reasonably believes will be collected. For all other customers, the Company
recognizes allowances for doubtful accounts based on the length of time the
receivables are past due, the current business environment and the Company's
historical experience.

ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE TRANSFERS

The Company from time to time enters into certain transactions with banks and
other third-party financing organizations with respect to the sale of a portion
of its accounts receivable in order to reduce the amount of working capital
required to fund such receivables. These transactions have been treated as sales
pursuant to the provisions of Financial Accounting Standards Board's (FASB)
Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 140, Accounting for Transfers
and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities. Fees, in
the form of discounts, are recorded as losses on the sale of assets, which are
included as a component of "Other expenses" in the Consolidated Statements of
Operations. The Company is the collection agent on behalf of the financing
organization for many of these arrangements and has no significant retained
interests or servicing liabilities related to accounts receivable that it has
sold, although in limited circumstances the Company may be required to
repurchase the accounts. See Note 9 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for
further discussion of these off-balance sheet transactions.

CONTRACT FINANCE RECEIVABLES

The Company offers financing of inventory and receivables to certain wireless
network operator customers and their authorized dealer agents and wireless
equipment manufacturers under contractual arrangements. Under these
arrangements, the Company records the accounts receivable from sales on behalf
of these customers and inventory and accounts payable for product purchased
under these arrangements, however, the Company has the ability to require these
customers, subject to certain limitations, to assume the accounts receivable or
repurchase the inventory that it has purchased on their behalf. Consequently,
the Company is financing these receivables and inventory and has a receivable
from these customers for amounts it has financed. The amount financed pursuant
to these arrangements is recorded as a current asset under the caption "Contract
financing receivable" and any trade accounts payable pursuant to the
arrangements is recorded as a current liability under the heading "Unfunded
portion of contract financing receivable." The Company charges a fee for
providing these contract financing services and records revenue for these
integrated logistics services at the amount of the net margin rather than the
gross amount of the transactions. In addition, the Company has commitments under
certain contracts to provide inventory financing for these customers pursuant to
various limitations and provisions as defined in the applicable service
agreements.

At December 31, 2003 and 2002, contract financing receivable of $10.8 million
and $17.0 million, respectively, included $1.9 million and $5.8 million,
respectively, of wireless products located at the Company's facilities. In
addition, at December 31, 2003 and 2002, the Company had $15.7 million and


A-12


1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

CONTRACT FINANCE RECEIVABLES (CONTINUED)

$22.1 million, respectively, in vendor payables related to purchases made for
these arrangements, which it considers to be the unfunded portion of these
receivables.

The Company's contract financing activities are provided to wireless network
operators and their authorized dealer agents and wireless equipment
manufacturers located in the United States and Australia. Decisions to grant
credit under these arrangements are generally at the discretion of the Company,
are made within guidelines established by the wireless network operators and
wireless equipment manufacturers and are subject to the Company's normal credit
granting and ongoing credit evaluation process. The Company's contract financing
services, and related fees, are included as an integral part of the Company's
integrated logistics services and are not separately computed or accounted for.
Integrated logistics service fees are included in revenues in the Statement of
Operations.

INVENTORIES

Inventories primarily consist of wireless devices and accessories and are stated
at the lower of cost (first-in, first-out method) or market. At each balance
sheet date, the Company evaluates its ending inventories for excess quantities
and obsolescence, considering any stock balancing or rights of return that it
may have with certain suppliers. This evaluation includes analyses of sales
levels by product and projections of future demand. The Company writes off
inventories that are considered obsolete. Remaining inventory balances are
adjusted to approximate the lower of cost or market value. Inventory adjustments
for obsolescence and lower of cost or market value may be expensed directly or
taken through the inventory valuation reserve, depending on the nature of the
adjustment. During the year ended December 31, 2003, the Company had no
individually significant inventory valuation adjustments. During the year ended
December 31, 2002, the Company made inventory valuation adjustments of
approximately $3.6 million to adjust inventories to their estimated net
realizable value or lower of cost or market and recognized a $2.6 million loss
related to a minimum purchase obligation to an accessories supplier in the U.S.

FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

The carrying amounts at December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, of cash and cash
equivalents, pledged cash, accounts receivable, contract financing receivable,
other current assets, accounts payable, accrued expenses, unfunded portion of
contract financing receivable and certain of the Company's credit facilities
approximate their fair values because of the short maturity of those
instruments. The carrying amount of short-term debt at December 31, 2003, 2002
and 2001, approximates fair value as this debt is revolving and has a variable
interest rate that fluctuates with market rates. See Note 4 and 12 for
disclosure of the fair value of the Company's investment in Chinatron Group
Holdings Limited ("Chinatron") Class B Preference Shares and the Company's
Convertible Notes, respectively.


A-13


1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT

Property and equipment are stated at cost and depreciation is computed using the
straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets, generally
three to fifteen years. Leasehold improvements are stated at cost and
depreciated ratably over the lease term of the associated property. Maintenance
and repairs are charged to expense as incurred.

IMPAIRMENT OF LONG-LIVED ASSETS

The Company periodically considers whether indicators of impairment of
long-lived assets are present. If such indicators are present, the Company
determines whether the sum of the estimated undiscounted cash flows attributable
to the assets in question is less than their carrying value. If less, the
Company recognizes an impairment loss based on the excess of the carrying amount
of the assets over their respective fair values. Fair value is determined by
discounted future cash flows, appraisals or other methods. If the assets
determined to be impaired are to be held and used, the Company recognizes an
impairment charge to the extent the present value of anticipated net cash flows
attributable to the asset are less than the asset's carrying value. The fair
value of the asset then becomes the asset's new carrying value, which the
Company depreciates over the remaining estimated useful life of the asset.

GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLES

The Company adopted the FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No.
142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets ("SFAS No. 142"), on January 1, 2002.
Pursuant to the provisions of SFAS 142 the Company stopped amortizing goodwill
and performs an impairment test on its goodwill at least annually. During the
second quarter of 2002, the Company completed the transitional impairment test
required under SFAS No. 142. During the first quarter of 2002, as a result of
the initial transitional impairment test, the Company recorded an impairment
charge of approximately $41 million, which is presented as a cumulative effect
of a change in accounting principle, net of tax. In the fourth quarter of 2003
and 2002, the Company performed the required annual impairment test on its
remaining goodwill and incurred no significant additional impairment charges.
The Company's reporting units are contained within three operating segments, the
Americas, Europe and Asia-Pacific as defined under SFAS 131, Disclosures about
Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information. Based on the fact that each
reporting unit constitutes a business, has discrete financial information with
similar economic characteristics, and the operating results of that component is
regularly reviewed by management, the Company applies the provisions of SFAS 142
and performs the necessary goodwill impairment tests at the reporting unit
level.

In addition to performing the required transitional impairment test on the
Company's goodwill, SFAS No. 142 required the Company to reassess the expected
useful lives of existing intangible assets including patents, trademarks and
trade names for which the useful life is determinable. At December 31, 2003,
these intangibles total $2.6 million, net of accumulated amortization of $1.3
million and are currently being amortized as required by SFAS 142 over three to
five years at approximately $400 thousand per year. The Company incurred no
impairment charges as a result of SFAS No. 142 for intangibles with determinable
useful lives, which are subject to amortization. In 2001, prior to adoption of
SFAS No. 142, goodwill amortization expense was $1.4 million or $0.17 on a per
share basis.


A-14


1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLES (CONTINUED)

The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill by operating segment for the year
ended December 31, 2003 are as follows (in thousands):



Europe Asia-Pacific Total
------- ------------ -------

Balance at December 31, 2002 $12,778 $ 280 $13,058
Goodwill from acquisitions 272 595 867
Effects of foreign currency fluctuation 2,644 138 2,782
------- ------- -------
Balance at December 31, 2003 $15,694 $ 1,013 $16,707
======= ======= =======


FOREIGN CURRENCY TRANSLATION

The functional currency for most of the Company's foreign subsidiaries is the
respective local currency. Revenue and expenses denominated in foreign
currencies are translated to the U.S. dollar at average exchange rates in effect
during the year and assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are
translated to the U.S. dollar at the exchange rate in effect at the end of the
period. Foreign currency transaction gains and losses are included in the
Consolidated Statements of Operations as a component of "Other expenses."
Currency translation of assets and liabilities (foreign investments) from the
functional currency to the U.S. dollar are included in the Consolidated Balance
Sheets as a component of accumulated other comprehensive loss in stockholders'
equity.

INCOME TAXES

The Company accounts for income taxes under the asset and liability method,
which requires the recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities for the
expected future tax consequence of events that have been recognized in the
Company's financial statements or income tax returns. Income taxes are
recognized during the year in which the underlying transactions are reflected in
the Consolidated Statements of Operations. Deferred taxes are provided for
temporary differences between amounts of assets and liabilities as recorded for
financial reporting purposes and amounts recorded for tax purposes. After
determining the total amount of deferred tax assets, the Company determines
whether it is more likely than not that some portion of the deferred tax assets
will not be realized. If the Company determines that a deferred tax asset is not
likely to be realized, a valuation allowance will be established against that
asset to record it at its expected realizable value.

DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS

The Company records amounts in discontinued operations (see Note 7 to the
Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion) as required by the
FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 144, Accounting for the
Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets ("SFAS No. 144"). In accordance with
the adoption of SFAS No. 144, the results of operations and related disposal
costs, gains and losses for business units that the Company has eliminated or
sold are classified in discontinued operations for all periods presented.


A-15


1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

NET INCOME (LOSS) PER SHARE

Basic net income (loss) per share is based on the weighted average number of
common shares outstanding during each year, and diluted net income (loss) per
share is based on the weighted average number of common shares and dilutive
common share equivalents outstanding during each year. The Company's common
share equivalents consist of stock options described in Note 14, to the
Consolidated Financial Statements.

On October 15, 2003 and August 15, 2003, the Company effected 3 for 2 common
stock splits, which the Company's Board of Directors approved. On June 26, 2002,
the Company's shareholders approved a 1 for 7 reverse split of its common stock
(effective June 27, 2002). Per share amounts for all periods presented in this
report have been adjusted to reflect this reverse stock split and the 3 for 2
common stock splits. The following is a reconciliation of the numerators and
denominators of the basic and diluted net income (loss) per share computations
for 2003, 2002 and 2001 (in thousands, except per share data):



YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31
2003 2002 2001
---------- ---------- --------

Income from continuing operations $ 12,955 $ 13,805 $ 3,098
Discontinued operations (1,226) (15,478) (56,399)
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle,
net of tax -- (40,748) --
---------- ---------- --------
Net income (loss) $ 11,729 $ (42,421) $(53,301)
========== ========== ========

Basic:
Weighted average shares outstanding 18,170 17,996 17,940
========== ========== ========

Per share amount:
Income from continuing operations $ 0.71 $ 0.77 $ 0.17
Discontinued operations (0.07) (0.86) (3.14)
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle,
net of tax -- (2.26) --
---------- ---------- --------
Net income (loss) $ 0.64 $ (2.35) $ (2.97)
========== ========== ========

Diluted:
Weighted average shares outstanding 18,170 17,996 17,940
Net effect of dilutive stock options-based on the treasury
stock method using average market price 832 23 1
---------- ---------- --------
Total weighted average shares outstanding 19,002 18,019 17,941
========== ========== ========

Per share amount:
Income from continuing operations $ 0.68 $ 0.77 $ 0.17
Discontinued operations (0.06) (0.86) (3.14)
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle,
net of tax -- (2.26) --
---------- ---------- --------
Net income (loss) $ 0.62 $ (2.35) $ (2.97)
========== ========== ========



A-16


1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

STOCK OPTIONS

As more fully discussed in Note 14 to the Consolidated Financial Statements, the
Company uses the intrinsic value method, as opposed to the fair value method, in
accounting for stock options. Under the intrinsic value method, no compensation
expense has been recognized for stock options granted to employees or stock sold
pursuant to the employee stock purchase plan ("ESPP"). The table below presents
a reconciliation of the Company's pro forma net income (loss) giving effect to
the estimated compensation expense related to stock options and the ESPP that
would have been reported if the Company utilized the fair value method (in
thousands, except per share data):



YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31
2003 2002 2001
---------- ---------- ----------

Net income (loss) as reported $ 11,729 $ (42,421) $ (53,301)
Stock-based employee compensation cost, net of related
tax effects, that would have been included in the
determination of net income (loss) if the fair value
method had been applied (713) (906) (712)
---------- ---------- ----------
Pro forma net income (loss) $ 11,016 $ (43,327) $ (54,013)
========== ========== ==========

Basic per share:
Net income (loss), as reported $ 0.64 $ (2.35) $ (2.97)
Stock-based employee compensation cost, net of related
tax effects, that would have been included in the
determination of net income (loss) if the fair value
method had been applied (0.03) (0.04) (0.04)
---------- ---------- ----------
Pro forma net income (loss) $ 0.61 $ (2.41) $ (3.01)
========== ========== ==========

Diluted per share:
Net income (loss), as reported $ 0.62 $ (2.35) $ (2.97)
Stock-based employee compensation cost, net of related
tax effects, that would have been included in the
determination of net income (loss) if the fair value
method had been applied (0.04) (0.05) (0.04)
---------- ---------- ----------
Pro forma net income (loss) $ 0.58 $ (2.40) $ (3.01)
========== ========== ==========


RECENTLY ISSUED ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

In 2003, Emerging Issues Task Force reached a consensus on the issue No. 00-21
("EITF 00-21"), Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliveries. EITF 00-21
addresses certain aspects of the accounting by a vendor for arrangements under
which it will perform multiple revenue-generating activities. Specifically, this
EITF 00-21 addresses how to determine whether an arrangement involving multiple
deliverables contains more than one unit of accounting. In applying EITF 00-21,
separate contracts with the same entity or related parties that are entered into
at or near the same time are presumed to have been negotiated as a package and
should, therefore, be evaluated as a single arrangement in considering whether
there are one or more units of accounting. EITF 00-21 is effective for revenue
arrangements entered into in periods (including quarterly periods) beginning
after June 15, 2003. The Company adopted this standard on a prospective basis.
The adoption of EITF 00-21 related to new agreements did not have an impact on
the financial position or results of operations of the Company.


A-17


1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

RECENTLY ISSUED ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS (CONTINUED)

Also in 2003, Emerging Issues Task Force reached a consensus on the issue No.
02-16 ("EITF 02-16"), Accounting by a Customer (Including a Reseller) for
Certain Consideration Received from a Vendor and No. 03-10("EITF 03-10"),
Application of Issue No. 02-16 by Resellers to Sales Incentives Offered to
Consumers by Manufacturers which address accounting for vendor programs. EITF
02-16 addressed accounting for cash consideration received by a reseller from a
vendor. Cash consideration received by a customer from a vendor is presumed to
be a reduction of the prices of the vendor's products or services and should be
characterized as a reduction of cost of sales when recognized in the customer's
income statement. However, if the consideration is a payment for assets or
services delivered to the vendor, the cash consideration is characterized as
revenue when recognized in the customer's income statement. The EITF also
addressed rebates or refunds and how they should be recognized as a reduction of
cost of sales. In order to recognize a rebate or refund, it must be probable and
reasonably estimable, otherwise, it is not recognized until each specified
criteria is met. EITF 03-10 addressed sales incentives that are offered to the
consumer by manufacturers that are honored by resellers. The consensus states
that these types of incentives should not be reported as a reduction of the
costs of the reseller's purchases from the vendor. If the consideration does not
meet the four specific criteria outlined in EITF 03-10, then the consideration
received is subject to the guidance in EITF 02-16. The Company has not changed
its presentation or accounting for vendor programs as a result of EITF 02-16 or
EITF 03-10. We believe that our current practices comply with both EITFs.

In December 2003, the United States Securities and Exchange Commission issued
Staff Accounting Bulletin ("SAB") No. 104 ("SAB 104"), Revenue Recognition. SAB
104 updates portions of the SEC staff's interpretive guidance provided in SAB
101 and included in Topic 13 of the Codification of Staff Accounting Bulletins.
SAB 104 deletes interpretative material no longer necessary, and conforms the
interpretive material retained, because of pronouncements issued by the
Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") Emerging Issues Task Force on
various revenue recognition topics, including EITF 00-21. The Company adopted
this standard on a prospective basis. The adoption of SAB 104 did not have an
impact on the financial position or results of operations of the Company.

In 2003, the FASB issued Interpretation No. 46 ("FIN 46"), Consolidation of
Variable Interest Entities. FIN 46 defines a variable interest entity ("VIE") as
a corporation, partnership, trust or any other legal structure that does not
have equity investors with a controlling financial interest or has equity
investors that do not provide sufficient financial resources for the entity to
support its activities. FIN 46 requires consolidation of a VIE by the primary
beneficiary of the assets, liabilities, and results of activities effective for
2003. FIN 46 also requires certain disclosures by all holders of a significant
variable interest in a VIE that are not the primary beneficiary. The Company
does not have any VIE's. The adoption of FIN No. 46 did not have a material
impact on the financial position or results of operations of the Company.

In May 2003, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No.
150, Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments with Characteristics of both
Liabilities and Equity ("SFAS No. 150"). SFAS No. 150 establishes standards for
how an issuer classifies and measures certain financial instruments with
characteristics of both liabilities and equity. It requires that an issuer
classify certain financial instruments as a liability (or as an asset in some
circumstances). SFAS No. 150 was effective for the


A-18


1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

RECENTLY ISSUED ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS (CONTINUED)

Company at the beginning of the first interim period beginning after June 15,
2003. The adoption of SFAS No. 150 did not have a material impact on the
financial position or results of operations of the Company.

In April 2003, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No.
149 ("SFAS No. 149"), Amendment of Statement 133 on Derivative Instruments and
Hedging Activities. SFAS No. 149 amends and clarifies accounting for derivative
instruments, including certain derivative instruments embedded in other
contracts, and for hedging activities under Statement 133 and is to be applied
prospectively to contracts entered into or modified after June 30, 2003. The
adoption of SFAS No. 149 did not have a material impact on the financial
position or results of operations of the Company.

In April 2003, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No.
149, Amendment of Statement 133 on Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities
("SFAS No. 149"). SFAS No. 149 amends and clarifies accounting for derivative
instruments, including certain derivative instruments embedded in other
contracts, and for hedging activities under Statement 133 and is to be applied
prospectively to contracts entered into or modified after June 30, 2003. The
adoption of SFAS No. 149 did not have a material impact on the financial
position or results of operations of the Company.

In April 2002, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No.
145, Rescission of FASB Statements No. 4, 44, and 64, Amendment of FASB
Statement No. 13, and Technical Corrections ("SFAS No. 145"). SFAS No. 145
rescinds FASB Statement No. 4, Reporting Gains and Losses from Extinguishment of
Debt, and an amendment of that Statement, FASB Statement No. 64, Extinguishments
of Debt Made to Satisfy Sinking-Fund Requirements. This Statement also rescinds
FASB Statement No. 44, Accounting for Intangible Assets of Motor Carriers. This
Statement amends FASB Statement No. 13, Accounting for Leases, to eliminate an
inconsistency between the required accounting for sale-leaseback transactions
and the required accounting for certain lease modifications that have economic
effects that are similar to sale-leaseback transactions. This Statement also
amends other existing authoritative pronouncements to make various technical
corrections, clarify meanings, or describe their applicability under changed
conditions. Upon adoption of SFAS No. 145 in January 2003, the Company
reclassified amounts previously reported as an extraordinary item, net of
related income tax effect, to a component of income from continuing operations.


A-19


1. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

OPERATING SEGMENTS

The Company's operations are divided into three geographic operating segments.
These operating segments represent its three divisions: The Americas,
Asia-Pacific and Europe. These divisions all derive revenues from sales of
wireless devices, accessory programs and fees from the provision of integrated
logistics services.

The Company evaluates the performance of, and allocates resources to, these
segments based on operating income from continuing operations including
allocated corporate selling, general and administrative expenses. As discussed
in Note 7 to the Consolidated Financial Statements, the Company discontinued
several operating entities, which materially affected certain operating
segments. All years presented below have been reclassified to reflect the
reclassification of discontinued operating entities to discontinued operations.
A summary of the Company's operations by segment is presented below (in
thousands) for 2003, 2002 and 2001:



Distribution Integrated Total Operating Allocated
Revenue from Logistics Services Revenue Income from Total Allocated Income
External Revenue from from External Continuing Segment Interest Tax Expense
Customers External Customers Customers Operations (1) Assets (2) Expense (3) (Benefit) (3)
------------ ------------------ ------------- -------------- ---------- ----------- -------------

2003:
ASIA-PACIFIC $ 962,682 $ 33,116 $ 995,798 $ 14,088 $ 159,005 $ 217 $ 3,117
THE AMERICAS 394,044 75,574 469,618 3,621 190,077 594 610
EUROPE 216,774 118,184 334,958 3,186 95,608 335 238
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
$1,573,500 $ 226,874 $1,800,374 $ 20,895 $ 444,690 $ 1,146 $ 3,965
========== ========== ========== ========== ========== ========== ==========

2002:
Asia-Pacific $ 504,866 $ 22,613 $ 527,499 $ 6,465 $ 84,920 $ 1,717 $ 476
The Americas 418,147 75,056 493,203 (2,030) 173,371 3,109 15,906
Europe 166,501 88,864 255,365 (3,688) 78,011 1,073 (1,202)
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
$1,089,534 $ 186,533 $1,276,067 $ 747 $ 336,302 $ 5,899 $ 15,180
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------

2001:
Asia-Pacific $ 324,031 $ 15,718 $ 339,749 $ 9,285 $ 98,539 $ 2,187 $ 1,541
The Americas 592,762 57,819 650,581 (6,481) 402,030 4,726 489
Europe 191,009 82,361 273,370 3,970 108,851 1,257 512
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
$1,107,802 $ 155,898 $1,263,700 $ 6,774 $ 609,420 $ 8,170 $ 2,542
========== ========== ========== ========== ========== ========== ==========


(1) Certain corporate expenses are allocated to the segments based on total
revenue.

(2) Corporate assets are included in the Americas segment.

(3) These items are allocated using various methods and are not necessarily
indicative of the actual interest expense and income taxes for the
applicable divisions.

Additional segment information is as follows (in thousands):



DECEMBER 31
----------------------------------
2003 2002 2001
-------- -------- --------

Long-lived assets:
Asia-Pacific $ 9,636 $ 7,479 $ 28,121
The Americas (1) 27,121 38,274 60,841
Europe 21,482 16,947 32,683
-------- -------- --------
$ 58,239 $ 62,700 $121,645
======== ======== ========


(1) Includes corporate assets.


A-20


2. FACILITY CONSOLIDATION CHARGE

During 2003, the Company consolidated its Richmond, California, call center
operation into its Plainfield, Indiana, facility to reduce costs and increase
productivity and profitability in its Americas division. During 2003, the
Company recorded a pre-tax charge of $5.5 million which includes approximately
$3.8 million for the present value of estimated lease costs, net of an
anticipated sublease, non-cash losses on the disposal of assets of approximately
$1.1 million and severance and other costs of approximately $600 thousand. In
establishing the original facility consolidation charge in the first quarter of
2003, certain estimates were made with respect to the timing and terms
associated with finding a sub-lessee for this property. The marketing of the
property has been more difficult than the Company originally anticipated. As a
result, in order to reflect the Company's current estimate of the costs
associated with the facility consolidation, the Company recorded the additional
$1 million facility consolidation charge in the fourth quarter of 2003. If the
Company continues to experience delays in sub-leasing the Richmond facility or
if the terms of any sub-lease are less favorable than anticipated, the Company
may incur additional costs associated with this facility consolidation.

Reserve activity for the facility consolidation as of December 31, 2003 is as
follows (in thousands):



Lease Employee
Termination Fixed Termination Other Exit
Costs Assets Costs Costs Total
----------- ------- ----------- ---------- -------

Provisions $ 3,829 $ 1,102 $ 269 $ 261 $ 5,461
Cash usage (450) -- (269) (252) (971)
Non-cash usage -- (1,102) -- -- (1,102)
------- ------- ------- ------- -------
DECEMBER 31, 2003 $ 3,379 $ -- $ -- $ 9 $ 3,388
======= ======= ======= ======= =======


3. LOSS OR GAIN ON DEBT EXTINGUISHMENT

On November 1, 2001, the Company's Board of Directors approved a plan under
which allowed the Company to repurchase its remaining 250,000 zero-coupon,
subordinated convertible notes due in the year 2018 ("Convertible Notes")
outstanding. Between January 1, and February 10, 2003, the Company repurchased
17,602 of its Convertible Notes outstanding. The aggregate purchase price for
the Convertible Notes was $9.7 million ($551 per Convertible Note). On March 11,
2003 the Company purchased 4,201 of the Convertible Notes pursuant to the
exercise of a put option by the bondholders at their accreted value of $2.3
million, which was paid in cash. The remaining 129 Convertible Notes were
redeemed on April 30, 2003 for $72 thousand ($555 per Convertible Note). In
2003, the Company recorded a loss on debt extinguishment related to these
transactions of $365 thousand. At December 31, 2003, there were no Convertible
Notes outstanding.

During 2002, the Company repurchased 228,068 of its 250,000 then outstanding
Convertible Notes. The aggregate purchase price for the Convertible Notes was
approximately $75 million (at an average cost of $329 per Convertible Note) and
was funded by a combination of working capital and a borrowing of $15 million
under the credit facility with General Electric Commercial Finance and the
Company's primary North American operating subsidiaries, Brightpoint North
America L.P. and Wireless Fulfillment Services, LLC. Approximately $30 million
of the working capital funding came from Brightpoint Holdings B.V., the


A-21


3. LOSS OR GAIN ON DEBT EXTINGUISHMENT (CONTINUED)

Company's primary foreign finance subsidiary. These transactions resulted in a
gain on debt extinguishment of $44 million.

During 2001, the Company repurchased 36,000 of its then outstanding Convertible
Notes for approximately $10 million (an average cost of $281 per Convertible
Note). These transactions resulted in a gain on debt extinguishment of $7.2
million.

4. IMPAIRMENT LOSS ON LONG-TERM INVESTMENT

As more fully discussed in Note 7, the Company received approximately $21
million face value of Chinatron Class B Preference Shares pursuant to its
divestiture of Brightpoint China Limited. The Chinatron Preference Shares were
convertible into ordinary shares of Chinatron at a ratio of 1:1, which
represented approximately a 19.9% interest in Chinatron at June 30, 2002.
Additionally, the provisions of the Chinatron shareholder agreement and the
Chinatron preference shares allow the Company to participate in certain capital
raising activities to protect the Company against dilution. As of June 30, 2002,
the Company estimated that its investment in Chinatron had a fair value of
approximately $10.3 million based on the Company's indirect ownership interest
and the projected discounted free cash flows of Chinatron. The $10.3 million
valuation of the Class B Preference Shares at June 30, 2002 was based on the
original discounted cash flow analysis used to calculate the initial value of
the Class B Preference Shares in the first quarter of 2002. At June 30, 2002,
there were no significant events or circumstances that occurred subsequent to
April 2002 that indicated the original discounted cash flow analysis required
updating.

On September 5, 2002, the Company agreed that the exchange ratio of its Class B
Preference Shares would change from 1:1 to 1:0.181275964 pursuant to the
successful completion of a private offering of 200,000,000 ordinary shares of
Chinatron at US$0.01 per share ($2 million). In addition, the Company declined
to subscribe for its pro rata portion of the offering and waived its rights to
receive 25% of the funds raised as a redemption on the Class B Preference
Shares, due to the Company's own liquidity constraints and to induce other
parties to invest in Chinatron.

On October 11, 2002, the Company declined to subscribe for its pro rata portion
of $5 million of loan notes and new warrants to be issued by Chinatron. The $5
million was comprised of $3 million in direct shareholder loans and $2 million
was provided in the form of shareholder guarantees to support an incremental $2
million of bank financing. Warrants to purchase 163,058,794 shares, totaling 39%
of the fully-diluted ordinary shares, of Chinatron were to be issued to
shareholders providing such loans and guarantees. The Company declined to
subscribe to its portion of the loan notes and warrants. Due to the Company's
liquidity constraints, the Company also waived its right to receive 25% of the
shareholder loans as redemption of the Class B Preference Shares to induce other
parties to invest in Chinatron.

In summary, the Company waived its rights to participate in the capital-raising
activities described above and agreed to modify the conversion ratio of the
preference shares. These actions reduced the Company's indirect ownership
interest in Chinatron from 19.9% to less than 1%. However, all other rights of
the Preference Shares, including the Company's rights to redeem all or a portion
of the Preference Shares under certain circumstances remained. The Company's
action helped secure additional funding for Chinatron, which the Company
believes improved Chinatron's ability to honor the remaining debt obligations of
the Preference Shares to the Company.


A-22


4. IMPAIRMENT LOSS ON LONG-TERM INVESTMENT (CONTINUED)

As previously stated, the initial estimate of the value of the Chinatron Class B
Preference shares was based on a discounted cash flow analysis calculating the
equity value of Chinatron and applying the pro rata ownership percentage
assuming conversion of the Class B Preference Shares to ordinary shares. Due to
the modification of the conversion ratio and the resulting dilution as set forth
above, the debt elements of the Chinatron Class B Preference Shares became
superior to the equity value. Considering internal and external valuations, the
Company determined the investment in Chinatron Class B Preference Shares had an
estimated fair market value of approximately $2 million. The loss was considered
"other than temporary" as defined by SFAS 115, Accounting for Certain
Investments in Debt and Equity Securities, ("SFAS 115") and consequently the
Company recorded a non-cash impairment charge of $8.3 million relating to its
investment in the Chinatron Class B Preference Shares during the third quarter
of 2002. Management was responsible for estimating the value of the Chinatron
Class B Preference Shares. In accordance with SFAS 115, the Company designated
the Chinatron Class B Preference Shares as held-to-maturity. The carrying value
was approximately $2 million at December 31, 2003 and 2002. Management currently
estimates there was no gross unrealized holding gain on this security.

5. INCOME TAX EXPENSE (BENEFIT)

For financial reporting purposes, income (loss) from continuing operations
before income taxes, by tax jurisdiction, is comprised of the following (in
thousands):



YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31
----------------------------------------
2003 2002 2001
-------- -------- --------

United States $ (6,118) $ 29,961 $ (5,215)
Foreign 23,014 (976) 10,855
-------- -------- --------
$ 16,896 $ 28,985 $ 5,640
======== ======== ========


The reconciliation for 2003, 2002 and 2001 of income tax expense (benefit)
computed at the U.S. Federal statutory tax rate to the Company's effective
income tax rate is as follows:



2003 2002 2001
------ ------ ------

Tax at U.S. Federal statutory rate 35.0% 35.0% 35.0%
State and local income taxes, net of U.S. Federal benefit (0.8) (1.7) 6.4
Net benefit of tax on foreign operations (10.0) 19.0 0.7
Other 0.7 0.1 3.0
------ ------ ------
23.5% 52.4% 45.1%
====== ====== ======



A-23


5. INCOME TAX EXPENSE (BENEFIT) (CONTINUED)

Significant components of the provision for income tax expense (benefit) from
continuing operations are as follows (in thousands):



YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31
----------------------------------------
2003 2002 2001
-------- -------- --------

Current:
Federal $ (3,011) $ (1,167) $ 4,166
State (491) 375 1,204
Foreign 5,457 3,120 3,640
-------- -------- --------
1,955 2,328 9,010
-------- -------- --------
Deferred:
Federal 1,323 11,606 (6,145)
State 289 684 465
Foreign 398 562 (788)
-------- -------- --------
2,010 12,852 (6,468)
-------- -------- --------
$ 3,965 $ 15,180 $ 2,542
======== ======== ========


Income tax expense (benefit) for 2003, 2002 and 2001 from discontinued
operations were $164 thousand, $(3.4) million and $(15.7) million, respectively.

Components of the Company's net deferred tax after valuation allowance are as
follows (in thousands):



DECEMBER 31
------------------------
2003 2002
-------- --------

Deferred tax assets:
Current:
Capitalization of inventory costs $ 345 $ 489
Allowance for doubtful accounts 370 546
Accrued liabilities and other 2,319 678
Noncurrent:
Depreciation -- 262
Other long-term investments 5,210 3,447
Net operating losses and other carryforwards 14,312 8,724
-------- --------
22,556 14,146
Valuation allowance (15,471) (8,682)
-------- --------
7,085 5,464
Deferred tax liabilities:
Noncurrent:
Depreciation (4,160) --
Other assets (4,018) (9,407)
-------- --------
(8,178) (9,407)
-------- --------
$ (1,093) $ (3,943)
======== ========


Income tax payments (receipts) were $5.1 million, $(8.4) million and $6.5
million in 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively.


A-24


5. INCOME TAX EXPENSE (BENEFIT) (CONTINUED)

At December 31, 2003, the Company had net operating loss carryforwards of
approximately $26 million, of which approximately $12 million have no expiration
date, approximately $1 million expires in 2011, and $13 million expires in 2023.
Undistributed earnings of the Company's foreign operations were approximately
$24 million at December 31, 2003. Those earnings are considered to be
indefinitely reinvested and, accordingly, no provision for U.S. federal or state
income taxes or foreign withholding taxes has been made. Upon distribution of
those earnings, the Company would be subject to U.S. income taxes (subject to a
reduction for foreign tax credits) and withholding taxes payable to the various
foreign countries. Determination of the amount of unrecognized deferred U.S.
income tax liability is not practicable; however, unrecognized foreign tax
credit carryovers may be available to reduce some portion of the U.S. tax
liability.

6. MINORITY INTEREST

On October 31, 2003, the Company sold 15% of its interest in Brightpoint India
Private Limited to Persequor Limited ("Persequor") in exchange for a management
services agreement, in which Persequor will provide management services to
Brightpoint India Private Limited for five years (ending October 31, 2008). On
the fourth anniversary of the effective date and annually thereafter, Persequor
has a right to require Brightpoint Holdings B.V. to purchase Persequor's
interest in Brightpoint India Private Limited at a price determined by an
appraisal method as defined in the shareholders' agreement. Termination of the
shareholders' agreement is the earlier of (i) the date on which each of the
Investors agree in writing or (ii) the tenth anniversary of the Effective Date.
Upon termination, Brightpoint India Private Limited becomes owned by its
shareholders and is no longer subject to a shareholders' agreement. As a result,
there are no options or puts subsequent to termination. As of December 31, 2003,
due to the relatively low capitalization of Brightpoint India Private Limited
and to operating losses related to start-up costs, the Company estimates the
value of the put option to be negligible. The Company may incur costs and
liabilities if the value of the put option increases over the period of the
shareholders' agreement. To the extent a liability is recorded, representing the
fair value of the put option in excess of the amount of minority interest
recorded, the associated charge will be reflected as a reduction of net income
to arrive at income available to common shareholders.

The minority interest of Brightpoint India Private Limited's profit (loss) is
calculated and recorded monthly. At no time will the minority interest on the
balance sheet be less than zero. The Company is assumed to be responsible for
all losses in excess of the minority's interest. When profits recover the excess
losses absorbed by the Company, minority interest will be recorded
proportionately.


A-25


7. DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS

At the beginning of 2002, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting
Standards No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived
Assets ("SFAS No. 144"). In connection with the adoption of SFAS No. 144, the
results of operations and related disposal costs, gains and losses for business
units that the Company has eliminated or sold are classified in discontinued
operations, for all periods presented.

Details of discontinued operations are as follows (in thousands):



YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31
-------------------------------------------
2003 2002 2001
--------- --------- ---------

Revenue $ 287 $ 119,731 $ 561,469
========= ========= =========
Loss from discontinued operations
Net operating loss $ (96) $ (8,705) $ (19,905)
Restructuring plan charges (64) (3,753) (2,193)
Other (538) (403) --
--------- --------- ---------
Total loss from discontinued operations (698) (12,861) (22,098)
--------- --------- ---------

Gain (loss) on disposal of discontinued operations
Restructuring plan charges (1,633) 1,380 (34,301)
Other (223) (3,059) --
Net loss on sale of Middle East operations _ (938) --
Recovery of contingent receivable 1,328 -- --
--------- --------- ---------
Total gain (loss) on disposal of discontinued operations (528) (2,617) (34,301)
--------- --------- ---------

Total discontinued operations $ (1,226) $ (15,478) $ (56,399)
========= ========= =========


Net assets, including reserves, related to discontinued operations are
classified in the Consolidated Balance Sheets as follows (in thousands):



DECEMBER 31
-------------------
2003 2002
------ ------

Total current assets $ 523 $8,113
Other non-current assets -- 177
------ ------
Total assets $ 523 $8,290
====== ======

Accounts payable $ 57 $ 898
Accrued expenses and other liabilities 2,760 5,141
------ ------
Total liabilities $2,817 $6,039
====== ======


Mexico operations

During the fourth quarter of 2002, the Company and certain of its subsidiaries
sold certain operating assets of Brightpoint de Mexico, S.A. de C.V. and their
respective ownership interests in Servicios Brightpoint de Mexico, S.A. de C.V.
to Soluciones Inteligentes para el Mercado Movil, S.A. de C.V., an entity which
is wholly-owned and controlled by Brightstar de Mexico S.A. de C.V. Pursuant to
the transaction, the Company received cash consideration totaling approximately
$1.7 million and a short-term promissory note from Soluciones Inteligentes para
el Mercado Movil, S.A. de C.V. totaling approximately $1.1 million that


A-26


7. DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS (CONTINUED)

matured in December 2002. The repayment of the promissory note was guaranteed by
Brightstar de Mexico S.A. de C.V. and was collected in full. The Company
recorded a net loss on the transaction of $2.2 million in 2002.

Middle East operations

During the third quarter of 2002, the Company and certain of its subsidiaries
sold their respective ownership interests in Brightpoint Middle East FZE, and
its subsidiary Fono Distribution Services LLC, and Brightpoint Jordan Limited to
Persequor Limited, an entity controlled by the former Managing Director of the
Company's operations in the Middle East and certain members of his management
team. Pursuant to the transaction, the Company received two subordinated
promissory notes with face values of $1.2 million and $3.0 million that mature
in 2004 and 2006, respectively. The notes bear interest at 4% per annum and were
recorded at a discount to face value. The aggregate carrying amount at December
31, 2003, was $3.4 million, of which $474 thousand is payable in 2004. The
Company recorded an initial loss on the transaction of $1.6 million, including
the recognition of accumulated foreign currency translation gains of $300
thousand in 2002. The Company received $1.3 million in contingent consideration
in 2003. This loss and the results of operations of the Company's former Middle
East operations are reflected in discontinued operations and prior periods have
been reclassified accordingly. Concurrent with the completion of this
transaction, $5 million of cash, which was pledged by Brightpoint Holdings B.V.
to support letters of credit utilized by the Company's operations in the Middle
East, was released and was classified as unrestricted. The Company has paid and
will pay management fees, including performance based bonuses, to Persequor for
providing management services relating to the export sales activities of
Brightpoint Asia Limited to certain markets in the Asia-Pacific division, which
the Company retained pursuant to the transaction.

2001 Restructuring Plan

During 2001, the Company's Board of Directors approved a restructuring plan
("2001 Restructuring Plan") that the Company began to implement in the fourth
quarter of 2001. The primary goal in adopting the 2001 Restructuring Plan was to
better position the Company for long-term and more consistent success by
improving its cost structure and divesting or closing operations in which the
Company believed potential returns were not likely to generate an acceptable
return on invested capital. Operations divested or closed included subsidiaries
in China, Brazil, Jamaica, South Africa, Venezuela and Zimbabwe, which had
unusually high risk profiles due to many factors, including, among other things,
high importation duties, currency restrictions and volatile political and
economic environments. The Company determined that the risks of operating in
these markets could no longer be justified given the profitability potential of
its operations in these markets, therefore, these operations were sold or
otherwise discontinued pursuant to the 2001 Restructuring Plan. During the
fourth quarter of 2001, the Company completed the sale of its former operations
in Jamaica (Brightpoint Jamaica Limited) pursuant to the 2001 Restructuring
Plan. The Company incurred a loss on this disposal of approximately $1.3 million
($800 thousand, net of tax).

The 2001 Restructuring Plan was also intended to improve the Company's cost
structure and, accordingly, the Company's former North America and Latin America
divisions were consolidated in 2001 and are managed as one division, referred to
as the Americas. Warehouse and logistics functions formerly based in Miami were
transferred to Indianapolis and the warehouse in Miami was closed. Additionally
the


A-27


7. DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS (CONTINUED)

Company's operations and activities in Germany, the Netherlands and Belgium,
including regional management, were consolidated into a new facility in Germany.
In total, the 2001 Restructuring Plan resulted in a headcount reduction of
approximately 350 employees across most areas of the Company, including
marketing, operations, finance and administration. In addition, the Miami
business and its sales office were closed during the second quarter of 2002.
This closure is reflected in discontinued operations and prior periods have been
reclassified accordingly.

2001 Restructuring Plan specific to the China operations

Additionally, pursuant to the 2001 Restructuring Plan, the Company completed in
January 2002, through certain of its subsidiaries, the formation of a joint
venture with Hong Kong-based Chinatron Group Holdings Limited ("Chinatron").
Chinatron is involved in the global wireless industry and, is beneficially
owned, in part, by the former managing director of Brightpoint China Limited and
by a former executive of Brightpoint, Inc. In addition, Jerre L. Stead, a
director of Brightpoint, Inc. was and remains a director of Chinatron. The
Company's Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, Robert J. Laikin,
and the former managing director of Brightpoint China Limited were founding
shareholders of Chinatron. Prior to the Company entering into the agreement to
form the joint venture, Mr. Laikin, disposed of his interest in Chinatron
primarily through the sale of his interest to a company owned by the former
managing director of Brightpoint China Limited and by a former executive of
Brightpoint, Inc. In exchange, Mr. Laikin received the unconditional promise
from their company to pay him $327,019 ($300,000 of which has been paid to
date).

In exchange for a 50% interest in Brightpoint China Limited pursuant to the
formation of the joint venture, the Company received Chinatron Class B
Preference Shares with a face value of $10 million. On April 29, 2002, the
Company announced that it had completed the sale of its remaining 50% interest
in Brightpoint China Limited to Chinatron. Pursuant to this transaction, the
Company received additional Chinatron Class B Preference Shares with a face
value of $11 million. In accordance with SFAS 115, Accounting for Certain
Investments in Debt and Equity Securities, the Company designated the Chinatron
Class B Preference Shares as held-to-maturity. The carrying value was
approximately $2 million at December 31, 2003 and 2002. See Note 4 to the
Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion regarding the Company's
investment in Chinatron Class B Preference Shares. Pursuant to these
transactions, Chinatron and the Company entered into a services agreement,
whereby Chinatron provides warehouse management services in Hong Kong supporting
the Company's Brightpoint Asia Limited operations managed by Persequor.

The Company recorded losses related to the sale of Brightpoint China Limited to
Chinatron of approximately $8.5 million during the three months ended March 31,
2002. Upon adoption of SFAS 142, as discussed below, the Company reclassified
these losses to cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle effective
January 1, 2002 as they related to goodwill that was required to be written-off
pursuant the transitional impairment test.


A-28


7. DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS (CONTINUED)

As of December 31, 2003, actions called for by the 2001 Restructuring Plan were
substantially complete, however, the Company expects to continue to record
adjustments through discontinued operations as necessary. The Company recorded
losses related to the 2001 Restructuring Plan as presented below (in thousands):



YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
----------------------------------------
2003 2002 2001
-------- -------- --------

Cash charges (credits):
Employee termination costs $ 20 $ 248 $ 1,677
Lease termination costs -- 592 1,257
Other exit costs 156 1,129 430
-------- -------- --------
Total cash charges (credits) 176 1,969 3,364
-------- -------- --------

Non-cash charges (credits):
Loss on investment -- (104) 12,732
Impairment of accounts receivable and
inventories of restructured operations (2) (848) 10,849
Impairment of fixed and other assets 72 3,366 4,834
Income tax effect of restructuring actions (125) 65 (12,132)
Write-off of cumulative foreign currency
translation adjustments 1,576 (2,074) 16,847
-------- -------- --------
Total non-cash charges (credits) 1,521 404 33,130
-------- -------- --------
Total restructuring plan charges $ 1,697 $ 2,373 $ 36,494
======== ======== ========


Utilization of the 2001 Restructuring Plan charges discussed above is as follows
(in thousands):



Lease Employee
Termination Termination Other Exit
Costs Costs Costs Total
----------- ----------- ---------- -------

January 1, 2001 $ -- $ -- $ -- $ --

Provisions (1) 314 619 1,810 2,743
------- ------- ------- -------
December 31, 2001 314 619 1,810 2,743


Provisions (1) 348 502 1,199 2,049
Cash usage (457) (1,096) (2,093) (3,646)
Non-cash usage -- -- (189) (190)
------- ------- ------- -------
December 31, 2002 $ 205 $ 25 $ 727 $ 957


PROVISIONS (1) 6 -- 41 47
CASH USAGE (201) (25) (214) (440)
NON-CASH USAGE -- -- (145) (145)
------- ------- ------- -------
DECEMBER 31, 2003 $ 10 $ -- $ 409 $ 419
======= ======= ======= =======


(1) Provisions do not include items that were directly expensed in the
period.


A-29


8. DIVESTITURES AND ACQUISITIONS

See Note 7 and 17 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for discussions of
the Company's divestiture activities.

During the first quarter of 2003, one of the Company's subsidiaries in France
acquired certain net assets of three entities that provided activation and other
services to the wireless telecommunications industry in France. The purpose of
these acquisitions was to expand the Company's customer base and geographic
presence in France. These transactions were accounted for as purchases and,
accordingly, the Consolidated Financial Statements include the operating results
of these businesses from the effective dates of the acquisitions. The combined
purchase price consisted of $600 thousand in cash. As a result of these
acquisitions, the Company recorded goodwill and other intangible assets totaling
approximately $2.0 million.

During the second quarter of 2003, the Company recorded $600 thousand of
goodwill related to the payment of certain earn-out arrangement on a prior
acquisition in the Asia-Pacific division.

During the second half of 2001, the Company acquired certain net assets of
Dirland SA and Mega-Hertz SARL. Both companies were providers of activation and
other services to the wireless industry in France. The purpose of these
acquisitions was to expand the Company's customer base and geographic presence
in France. These transactions were accounted for as purchases and, accordingly,
the Consolidated Financial Statements include the operating results of these
businesses from the effective dates of the acquisitions. The combined purchase
price consisted of $5.3 million in cash and the assumption of certain
liabilities. As a result of these acquisitions, the Company recorded goodwill
and other intangible assets totaling approximately $5.5 million.

The impact of the acquisitions discussed above was not material in relation to
the Company's consolidated results of operations. Consequently, pro forma
information is not presented.

9. ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE TRANSFERS

During the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002, the Company entered into
certain transactions or agreements with banks and other third-party financing
organizations in Ireland, Norway, Sweden, Australia, Mexico and France with
respect to the sale of a portion of its accounts receivable in order to reduce
the amount of working capital required to fund such receivables. These
transactions have been treated as sales pursuant to current accounting
principles generally accepted in the United States and, accordingly, are
accounted for as off-balance sheet arrangements.

Net funds received from the sales of accounts receivable during the years ended
December 31, 2003 and 2002 totaled $279 million and $216 million, respectively.
Fees, in the form of discounts, incurred in connection with these sales totaled
$1.4 million and $1.9 million during 2003 and 2002, respectively, and were
recorded as losses on the sale of assets. Approximately $1.4 million and $1.2
million in 2003 and 2002, respectively, of these fees relate to continuing
operations and are included as a component of "Other expenses" in the
Consolidated Statements of Operations. The remainder of the fees in 2002 were
related to our former Mexico operations and were included in loss from
discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Operations.


A-30


9. ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE TRANSFERS (CONTINUED)

The Company is the collection agent on behalf of the third-party financing
organization for many of these arrangements and has no significant retained
interests or servicing liabilities related to accounts receivable that it has
sold. In certain circumstances, the Company may be required to repurchase the
corresponding accounts receivable sold, including, but not limited to, accounts
receivable in dispute or otherwise not collectible, credit insurance is not
maintained, a violation of, the expiration or early termination of the agreement
pursuant to which these arrangements are conducted. During 2003 and 2002, as a
result of the recourse arrangements, the Company repurchased approximately $234
thousand and $1.1 million of receivables, respectively, from banks or other
third party financing institutions. These agreements require the Company's
subsidiaries to provide collateral in the form of pledged assets and/or, in
certain situations, a guarantee by the Company of its subsidiaries' obligations.

Pursuant to these arrangements, approximately $46 million and $30 million of
trade accounts receivable were sold to and held by banks and other third-party
financing institutions at December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively. Amounts held
by banks or other financing institutions at December 31, 2003 were for
transactions related to our Ireland, France, Sweden and Norway arrangements. All
other arrangements have been terminated or expired.

10. PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT

The components of property and equipment are as follows (in thousands):



DECEMBER 31
2003 2002
-------- --------

Furniture and equipment $ 14,675 $ 15,595
Information systems equipment and software 64,692 59,445
Leasehold improvements 5,550 5,766
-------- --------
84,917 80,806
Less accumulated depreciation (55,351) (45,110)
-------- --------
$ 29,566 $ 35,696
======== ========


Depreciation expense charged to continuing operations was $12.7 million, $12.1
million and $10.4 million in 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively.


A-31



11. LEASE ARRANGEMENTS

The Company leases its office and warehouse space as well as certain furniture
and equipment under operating leases. Total rent expense for these operating
leases was $10.8 million, $9.2 million and $13.4 million for 2003, 2002 and
2001, respectively.

The aggregate future minimum payments on the above leases are as follows (in
thousands):



Year ending
December 31
- ------------

2004 $ 9,340
2005 6,830
2006 6,309
2007 4,825
2008 4,829
Thereafter* 47,570
---------
$ 79,703
=========


*Includes approximately $45 million related to the Company's 495,000
square foot facility located in Plainfield, Indiana, which the initial
lease term expires in 2019.

On February 19, 2003, the Company announced that it would consolidate its
Richmond, California, call center operation into its Plainfield, Indiana,
facility. The operating lease for the facility in Richmond, California, expires
in March of 2009. These future minimum lease payments are not included above,
which total $5.8 million. Refer to Note 2 for additional information.

12. LINES OF CREDIT AND CONVERTIBLE NOTES



OUTSTANDING AT DECEMBER 31
--------------------------------
CREDIT AGREEMENTS 2003 2002
- ----------------- --------- ---------

Lines of Credit - the Americas $ -- $ --
- Asia-Pacific 16,171 10,052
- Europe 36 51
Convertible Notes -- 12,017
--------- ---------
Total $ 16,207 $ 22,120
--------- ---------


Lines of Credit -Americas Division

On October 31, 2001, the Company's primary North American operating
subsidiaries, Brightpoint North America L.P. and Wireless Fulfillment Services,
LLC (the "Borrowers"), entered into a new revolving credit facility (the
Revolver) with General Electric Capital Corporation (GE Capital), which has been
amended from time to time, to provide capital for its North American operations.
GE Capital acted as agent for a syndicate of banks ("the Lenders"). The Revolver
expires in October of 2004. The Revolver provides borrowing availability,
subject to borrowing base calculations and other limitations, of up to a maximum
of


A-32


12. LINES OF CREDIT AND CONVERTIBLE NOTES (CONTINUED)

$70 million and currently bears interest, at the Borrowers' option, at the prime
rate plus 0.75% or LIBOR plus 2.25%. The applicable interest rate that the
Borrowers are subject to can be adjusted quarterly based upon certain financial
measurements defined in the Revolver. The Revolver is guaranteed by Brightpoint,
Inc. and is secured by, among other things, all of the Borrowers' assets. The
Company also has pledged certain intellectual property and the capital stock of
certain of its subsidiaries as collateral for the Revolver. The Revolver is a
secured asset-based facility where a borrowing base is calculated periodically
using eligible accounts receivable and inventory, subject to certain
adjustments. Eligible accounts receivable and inventories fluctuate over time,
which can increase or decrease borrowing availability. The terms of the Revolver
include negative covenants that, among other things, limit the Borrowers'
ability to sell certain assets and make certain payments outside the normal
course of business, as well as prohibit us from amending the terms of our
distribution agreement with Nokia Inc. in the United States without the prior
written consent of GE Capital. The provisions of the Revolver are such that if
the Company's borrowing availability falls between $12.5 million and $10.0
million, the Company is subject, during such time, to a minimum fixed charge
coverage ratio as defined in the Revolver. If the Company's borrowing
availability falls below $10.0 million, the Company is then subject at all times
thereafter to a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio as defined in the Revolver.
The provisions of the Revolver require the Company to maintain at all times a
minimum borrowing availability of $7 million. Any of the following events could
cause the Company to be in default under the Revolver, including but not limited
to, (i) the expiration or termination of the Company's distribution agreement in
the United States with Nokia Inc., (ii) a change in control of the Company,
(iii) failure of the Company to maintain a tangible net worth, subject to
certain adjustments, of at least $75 million, (iv) the borrowing availability
under the Revolver falling below $7 million, or (v) the violation of the
applicable fixed charge coverage ratio. In the event of default, the Lenders may
(i) terminate all or a portion of the Revolver with respect to further advances
or the incurrence of further letter of credit obligations, (ii) declare all or
any portion of the obligations due and payable and require any and all of the
letter of credit obligations be cash collateralized, or (iii) exercise any
rights and remedies provided to the Lenders under the loan document or at law or
equity. Additionally, the Lenders may increase the rate of interest applicable
to the advances and the letters of credit to the default rate as defined in the
agreement.

Subject to certain restrictions and limitations set forth in the Revolver, the
Company was able to use certain proceeds under the Revolver to repurchase its
then outstanding Convertible Notes. At December 31, 2003 and 2002, there were no
amounts outstanding under the Revolver with available funding, net of the
applicable required availability minimum of $32 million and $30 million
respectively. At December 31, 2003, 2002, and 2001, the Company was in
compliance with the covenants in its credit agreements. Interest payments were
approximately $400 thousand, $1.4 million and $4.3 million, respectively.

According to EITF 95-22, Balance Sheet Classification of Borrowings Outstanding
under Revolving Credit Agreements That Include both a Subjective Acceleration
Clause and a Lock-Box Arrangement, borrowings outstanding under a revolving
credit agreement that includes both a subjective acceleration clause and a
requirement to maintain a lock-box arrangement, whereby remittances from the
borrower's customers reduce the debt outstanding, are considered short-term
obligations. The Revolver meets these criteria. Accordingly, borrowings under
the North America, Australia, and New Zealand facility are classified as
current.


A-33


12. LINES OF CREDIT AND CONVERTIBLE NOTES (CONTINUED)

Lines of Credit - Asia-Pacific

In December of 2002, the Company's primary Australian operating subsidiaries,
Brightpoint Australia Pty Ltd and Advanced Portable Technologies Pty Limited,
entered into a revolving credit facility ("the Facility") with GE Commercial
Finance in Australia. The Facility, which matures in December of 2005, provides
borrowing availability, subject to borrowing base calculations and other
limitations, of up to a maximum amount of 50 million Australian dollars
(approximately $38 million U.S. dollars at December 31, 2003). Borrowings on the
Facility were used to repay borrowings under its former Westpac overdraft
facility discussed below and to repay intercompany loans with Brightpoint
Holdings B.V., the Company's primary foreign finance subsidiary. Future
borrowings under the Facility will be used for general working capital purposes.
The Facility is subject to certain financial covenants, which include
maintaining a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio and bears interest at the Bank
Bill Swap Reference rate plus 2.9%. The Facility is a secured asset-based
facility where a borrowing base is calculated periodically using eligible
accounts receivable and inventory, subject to certain adjustments. Eligible
accounts receivable and inventories fluctuate over time, which can increase or
decrease borrowing availability. At December 31, 2003 and 2002, there was $11.9
million and $10.1 million outstanding under the Facility at an interest rate of
approximately 7.8% with available funding of $13.4 million and $10.7 million,
respectively.

In December of 2003, the Company's Brightpoint India Private Limited subsidiary
entered into a short-term credit facility with ABN Amro. At December 31, 2003,
$4.3 million was outstanding at a variable interest rate of 6.5% based on the
prime rate in India. In January 2004, this credit facility was paid and
terminated.

In July of 2003, the Company's primary operating subsidiary in the Philippines,
Brightpoint Philippines, Inc. entered into a credit facility with Banco de Oro.
The facility, which matures in April of 2004, provides borrowing availability,
up to a maximum amount of 50 million Philippine Pesos (approximately $900
thousand U.S. dollars, at December 31, 2003), guaranteed by Brightpoint, Inc.
The facility bears interest at the Prime Lending Rate (9.5% at December 31,
2003). At December 31, 2003, the facility had no amounts outstanding with
available funding of approximately $900 thousand dollars.

In May of 2003, the Company's primary operating subsidiary in the Philippines,
Brightpoint Philippines, Inc. entered into a credit facility with Chinabank. The
facility, which matures in April of 2004, provides borrowing availability, up to
a maximum amount of 50 million Philippine Pesos (approximately $900 thousand
U.S. dollars, at December 31, 2003), guaranteed by Brightpoint, Inc. The
facility bears interest at the Prime Lending Rate (currently 10.25%). At
December 31, 2003, the facility had no amounts outstanding with available
funding of approximately $900 thousand dollars.

In November 2003, the Company's primary operating subsidiary in New Zealand,
Brightpoint New Zealand Limited, entered into a revolving credit facility with
GE Commercial Finance in Australia. The Facility, which matures in November of
2006, provides borrowing availability, subject to borrowing base calculations
and other limitations, of up to a maximum amount of 12 million New Zealand
dollars (approximately $7.9 million U.S. dollars at December 31, 2003). Future
borrowings under the Facility will be used for general working capital purposes.
The Facility is subject to certain financial covenants, which include
maintaining a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio and bears interest at the New
Zealand Index rate plus 3.15%. The Facility is a secured asset-based facility
where a borrowing base is calculated periodically using eligible accounts
receivable and inventory, subject to certain adjustments. Eligible accounts
receivable and inventories fluctuate


A-34


12. LINES OF CREDIT AND CONVERTIBLE NOTES (CONTINUED)

over time, which can increase or decrease borrowing availability. At December
31, 2003, there were no amounts outstanding under the Facility with available
funding of approximately $3.9 million.

Lines of Credit - Europe

During 2001, one of the Company's subsidiaries in France, Brightpoint (France)
SARL, entered into a short-term line of credit facility with Natexis Banque.
During the third quarter of 2002, this facility was terminated, at which time
Brightpoint (France) SARL and Natexis Banque entered into an agreement whereby
Natexis Banque purchases certain accounts receivable from Brightpoint (France)
SARL. See Note 9 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

The Company's primary operating subsidiary in Sweden, Brightpoint Sweden AB, has
a short-term line of credit facility with SEB Finans AB. The facility has
borrowing availability of up to 15 million Swedish Krona (approximately $2.1
million U.S. dollars at December 31, 2003) and bears interest at the SEB Banken
Base plus 1%. The facility is supported by a guarantee provided by the Company.
At December 31, 2003 and 2002, there were no amounts outstanding under this
facility.

Convertible Notes

On March 11, 1998, the Company completed the issuance of zero-coupon,
subordinated, convertible notes due in the year 2018 ("Convertible Notes") with
an aggregate face value of $380 million ($1,000 per Convertible Note) and a
yield to maturity of 4.00%. The Convertible Notes were subordinated to all
existing and future senior indebtedness of the Company and all other
liabilities, including trade payables of the Company's subsidiaries. The
Convertible Notes resulted in gross proceeds to the Company of approximately
$172 million (issue price of $452.89 per Convertible Note) and required no
periodic cash payments of interest. The proceeds were used initially to reduce
borrowings under the Company's revolving credit facility and to invest in
highly-liquid, short-term investments pending use in operations. On October 30,
2000, the Company announced that its Board of Directors had approved a plan
under which the Company could repurchase up to 130,000 Convertible Notes. During
the fourth quarter of 2000, the Company repurchased 94,000 Convertible Notes
under the plan for approximately $29 million (at an average cost of $310 per
Convertible Note) and realized an extraordinary gain, net of tax, on the
repurchases of approximately $10.0 million. During the first quarter of 2001,
the Company repurchased the remaining 36,000 Convertible Notes under the plan
for approximately $10.1 million (at an average cost of $281 per Convertible
Note) and realized an extraordinary gain, net of tax, of approximately $7.2
million. As of March 31, 2001, the Company's plan to repurchase 130,000
Convertible Notes was completed.

On November 1, 2001, the Company announced that its Board of Directors had
approved another plan under which the Company may repurchase the remaining
250,000 Convertible Notes. During 2002, the Company repurchased 228,068 or 91%
of the 250,000 outstanding Convertible Notes pursuant to the plan. The aggregate
purchase price for the Convertible Notes was approximately $75 million (at an
average cost of $329 per Convertible Note) and was funded by a combination of
working capital and a borrowing of $15 million under the credit facility with
General Electric Commercial Finance and the Company's primary North American
operating subsidiaries, Brightpoint North America L.P. and Wireless Fulfillment
Services, LLC. Approximately $30 million of the working capital funding came
from Brightpoint Holdings B.V., the Company's primary foreign finance
subsidiary. These transactions resulted in a gain, of approximately $44 million.
The tax effect of the Convertible Note repurchases was largely offset by net
operating losses resulting in no significant cash tax payments. As of December
31, 2002, the remaining 21,932 Convertible


A-35


12. LINES OF CREDIT AND CONVERTIBLE NOTES (CONTINUED)

Notes had an accreted book value of approximately $12.0 million or $548 per
Convertible Note, which approximated the fair value.

Between January 1, and February 10, 2003, the Company repurchased an additional
17,602 Convertible Notes for a total cost of $9.7 million ($551 per Convertible
Note), with an accreted value of $9.7 million ($551 per Convertible Note). On
March 11, 2003 the Company purchased 4,201 of the Convertible Notes pursuant to
the exercise of a put option by the bondholders at their accreted value of $3.1
million, which was paid in cash. As of March 12, 2003, there were 129
Convertible Notes outstanding with an accreted value of approximately $71
thousand. The remaining 129 Convertible Notes were redeemed by the Company for
cash equal to the issue price plus accrued original issue discount through the
date of redemption or $555 per Convertible Note.

13. GUARANTEES

In 2002, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Interpretation No. 45
(FIN 45), Guarantor's Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees,
Including Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others. FIN 45 requires
guarantees to be recorded at fair value and requires a guarantor to make
significant new disclosure, even when the likelihood of making any payments
under the guarantee is remote.

The Company has issued certain guarantees on behalf of its subsidiaries with
regard to lines of credit and long-term debt, for which the liability is
recorded in the Company's financial statements. Although the guarantees relating
to lines of credit and long-term debt are excluded from the scope of FIN 45, the
nature of these guarantees and the amount outstanding are described in Note 12
to the consolidated financial statements.

In some circumstances the Company purchases inventory with payment terms
requiring letters of credit. As of December 31, 2003, the Company has issued $28
million in standby letters of credit. These standby letters of credit are
generally issued for a one-year term and are supported by either availability
under the Company's credit facilities or cash deposits. The underlying
obligations for which these letters of credit have been issued are recorded in
the financial statements at their full value. Should the Company fail to pay its
obligation to one or all of these suppliers, the suppliers may draw on the
standby letter of credit issued for them. The maximum future payments under
these letters of credit are $28 million.

Additionally, the Company has issued certain guarantees on behalf of its
subsidiaries with regard to accounts receivable transferred, the nature of which
is described is described in Note 9. While we do not currently anticipate the
funding of these guarantees, the maximum potential amount of future payments
under these guarantees at December 31, 2003 is approximately $46 million.

The Company has entered into indemnification agreements with its officers and
directors, to the extent permitted by law, pursuant to which the Company has
agreed to reimburse its officers and directors for legal expenses in the event
of litigation and regulatory matters. The terms of these indemnification
agreements provide for no limitation to the maximum potential future payments.
The Company has a directors and officers insurance policy that may mitigate the
potential liability and payments.


A-36


14. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

In 2003, the Board of Directors approved two 3 for 2 stock splits in the form of
stock dividends primarily to increase the liquidity of the stock, increase the
number of shares in the market and to improve the affordability of the stock for
investors. All references in the financial statements related to share amounts,
per share amounts, average shares outstanding and information concerning stock
option plans have been adjusted retroactively to reflect stock splits, including
the Company's 3 for 2 stock splits of its common stock effective August 25 and
October 15, 2003 and the 1 for 7 reverse split of its common stock effective
June 27, 2002.

The Company has a Stockholders' Rights Agreement, commonly known as a "poison
pill," which provides that in the event an individual or entity becomes a
beneficial holder of 15% or more of the shares of the Company's capital stock,
other stockholders of the Company shall have the right to purchase shares of the
Company's (or in some cases, the acquiror's) common stock at 50% of its then
market value.

The Company has authorized 1.0 million shares of preferred stock, which remain
unissued. The Board of Directors has not yet determined the preferences,
qualifications, relative voting or other rights of the authorized shares of
preferred stock.

STOCK OPTION PLANS

The Company has three fixed stock option plans, which reserve shares of common
stock for issuance to executives, key employees, directors and others.

The Company maintains the 1994 Stock Option Plan whereby employees of the
Company and others are eligible to be granted incentive stock options or
non-qualified stock options. Under this plan there are 3.4 million common shares
reserved for issuance of which 1.3 million and 2.0 million were authorized but
unissued at December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively. The Company also maintains
the 1996 Stock Option Plan whereby employees of the Company and others are
eligible to be granted non-qualified stock options. Under this plan there are
1.8 million common shares reserved for issuance of which 0.8 million and 1.2
million were authorized but unissued at December 31, 2003 and 2002. For both
plans, the Compensation and Human Resources Committee of the Board of Directors
determines the time or times at which the options will be granted, selects the
employees or others to whom options will be granted and determines the number of
shares covered by each option, as well as the purchase price, time of exercise
(not to exceed ten years from the date of the grant) and other terms of the
option.

The Company also maintains the Non-Employee Directors Stock Option Plan whereby
non-employee directors are eligible to be granted non-qualified stock options.
Under this plan there are 0.3 million common shares reserved for issuance of
which 0.1 million and 0.2 million were authorized but unissued at December 31,
2003 and 2002. In years prior to 2003, options to purchase 10,000 shares of
common stock were granted to each newly elected non-employee director and, on
the first day of each year, each individual elected and continuing as a
non-employee director received an option to purchase 4,000 shares of common
stock. Effective as of December 31, 2002, no further grants shall be made under
the plan by action of the Board of Directors of the Company.


A-37


14. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (CONTINUED)

The exercise price of stock options granted may not be less than the fair market
value of a share of common stock on the date of the grant. Options become
exercisable in periods ranging from one to three years after the date of the
grant. Information regarding these option plans for 2003, 2002 and 2001 is as
follows:



2003 2002 2001
------------------------------ ----------------------------- -----------------------------
WEIGHTED Weighted Weighted
AVERAGE Average Average
EXERCISE Exercise Exercise
SHARES PRICE Shares Price Shares Price
----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- ----------- ----------

Options outstanding, 3,071,567 $ 10.03 1,643,033 $ 20.76 2,422,067 $ 32.29
beginning of year
Options granted 104,125 8.36 1,806,241 2.94 307,626 11.66
Options exercised (1,199,042) 10.27 -- -- -- --
Options canceled (465,739) 18.87 (377,707) 22.81 (1,086,660) 43.66
----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- ----------- ----------
Options outstanding,
end of year 1,510,911 $ 7.00 3,071,567 $ 10.03 1,643,033 $ 20.76
=========== =========== =========== ========== =========== ==========
Options exercisable,
end of year 326,890 $ 18.00 1,117,751 $ 19.48 980,898 $ 22.92
=========== =========== =========== ========== =========== ==========

Option price range at end
of year $0.66-$30.18 $0.66-$54.45 $8.46-$59.31
Option price range for
exercised shares $0.66 - $20.91 -- --
Options available for grant
at year end 685,663 324,049 1,816,867
Weighted average fair value
of options granted during
the year $9.64 $2.94 $11.66


On August 31, 2001, the Company made an offer (Offer to Exchange), to its
employees and members of the Board of Directors of the Company, to exchange all
options to purchase shares of its common stock outstanding under the Company's
1994 Stock Option Plan, 1996 Stock Option Plan and Non-Employee Directors Stock
Option Plan which options had (i) a grant date prior to March 1, 2001, and (ii)
an exercise price in excess of $70.00 per share. In exchange for the options,
the participants (a) received a cash payment and (b) received the grant of a new
option or new options, as applicable, in the amounts upon the terms and subject
to the conditions as set forth in the Offer to Exchange.

This Offer expired on October 15, 2001. The total amount of cash paid and
recognized as compensation expense in 2001 pursuant to the Offer to Exchange was
approximately $400 thousand. The individuals that were eligible and elected to
participate in the Offer were granted a new option or new options, as
applicable, on the first business day, which is at least six months and one day
from the cancellation date. The number of shares subject to the new option or
new options, as applicable, was equal to one-third of the shares subject to the
options tendered and accepted by the Company for cancellation, rounded up to the
nearest whole share.


A-38


14. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (CONTINUED)

The following table summarizes information about the fixed price stock options
outstanding at December 31, 2003.



Exercisable
Weighted -------------------------------
Number Average Number
Outstanding at Remaining Weighted Outstanding at Weighted
Range of December 31, Contractual Average December 31, Average
Exercise Prices 2003 Life Exercise Price 2003 Exercise Price
--------------- -------------- ----------- -------------- --------------- --------------

$ 0.66 - $ 2.10 363,475 4 years $ 1.84 67,485 $ 1.68
$ 2.49 - $ 2.83 237,237 3 years $ 2.74 4,754 $ 2.83
$ 3.86 - $ 5.23 517,500 4 years $ 3.89 11,250 $ 3.86
$ 5.37 - $ 13.22 166,039 3 years $ 9.28 40,668 $ 12.03
$ 14.19 - $ 30.18 226,660 2 years $ 25.14 202,733 $ 25.77
--------- -------
1,510,911 326,890
--------- -------


Disclosure of pro forma information regarding net income and earnings per share
is required to be presented as if the Company has accounted for its employee
stock options under the fair value method. The fair value for options granted by
the Company is estimated at the date of grant using a Black-Scholes option
pricing model with the following weighted-average assumptions:



2003 2002 2001
---- ---- ----

Risk-free interest rate 2.47% 2.74% 5.47%
Dividend yield 0.00% 0.00% 0.00%
Expected volatility .85 .84 .74
Expected life of the options (years) 3.20 2.75 2.76


The Black-Scholes option valuation model was developed for use in estimating the
fair value of traded options, which have no vesting restrictions and are fully
transferable. In addition, option valuation models require the input of highly
subjective assumptions including expected stock price volatility. Because the
Company's employee stock options have characteristics significantly different
from those of traded options, and because changes in the subjective input
assumptions can materially affect the fair value estimate, in management's
opinion, the existing models do not necessarily provide a reliable single
measure of the fair value of its employee stock options.

EMPLOYEE STOCK PURCHASE PLAN

During 1999, the Company's shareholders approved the 1999 Brightpoint, Inc.
Employee Stock Purchase Plan (ESPP). The ESPP, available to substantially all
employees of the Company, is designed to comply with Section 423 of the Internal
Revenue Code for employees living in the United States and eligible employees
may authorize payroll deductions of up to 10% of their monthly salary to
purchase shares of the Company's common stock at 85% of the lower of the fair
market value as of the beginning or ending of each month. Each employee is
limited to a total monthly payroll deduction of $2,000 for ESPP purchases. The
Company reserved 2,000,000 shares for issuance under the ESPP. During 2003, 2002
and 2001, employees made contributions to the ESPP to purchase 6,249, 41,662,
and 13,390 shares, respectively, at a weighted-average price of $11.72, $2.65
and $18.41 per share, respectively.


A-39


14. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (CONTINUED)

EMPLOYEE STOCK PURCHASE PLAN (CONTINUED)

The Company accounts for the Employee Stock Purchase Plan ("ESPP") and the 15%
discount offered to employees who purchase shares through the Plan under APB 25.
The ESPP meets the four characteristics of a non-compensatory plan under
paragraph 7 of APB 25. Accordingly, no compensation expense is recorded for the
15% discount under APB 25.

15. EMPLOYEE SAVINGS PLAN

The Company maintains an employee savings plan, which permits employees based in
the United States with at least thirty days of service to make contributions by
salary reduction pursuant to section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code. After
one year of service, the Company matches 50% of employee contributions, up to 6%
of each employee's salary in cash. Prior to 2002, the Company matched 25% of
employee contributions, up to 6% of each employee's salary in the Company's
common stock. In connection with the required match, the Company's contributions
to the Plan were $300 thousand, $300 thousand and $200 thousand in 2003, 2002
and 2001, respectively. The employee savings plan was restated in 2001 in order
to comply with certain laws that have become effective since the Plan's last
amendment. Effective January 1, 2002, the Plan was amended to allow employees to
direct the investment of their Company matching contributions in any of the
Plan's investment options including Company common stock. Effective May 1, 2002,
the plans investment in the Company's common stock fund was closed to new
contributions and incoming transfers and participating employees were able to
direct their pre-2002 matching contribution accounts either remain invested in
Company stock or be transferred to other Plan investment funds.

16. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS AND CONTINGENCIES

The Company is from time to time involved in certain legal proceedings in the
ordinary course of conducting its business. While the ultimate liability
pursuant to these actions cannot currently be determined, the Company believes
these legal proceedings will not have a material adverse effect on its financial
position.

The Company's subsidiary in South Africa, whose operations were discontinued
pursuant to the 2001 Restructuring Plan, has received an assessment from the
South Africa Revenue Service ("SARS") regarding value-added taxes the SARS
claims are due, relating to certain product sale and purchase transactions
entered into by the Company's subsidiary in South Africa from 2000 to 2002.
Although the Company's liability pursuant to this assessment by the SARS, if
any, cannot currently be determined, the Company believes the range of the
potential liability is between $0 and $1.2 million U.S. dollars (at current
exchange rates) including penalties and interest. The potential assessment is
not estimable and, therefore, is not reflected as a liability or recorded as an
expense.

A complaint was filed on November 23, 2001 against us and 87 other defendants in
the United States District Court for the District of Arizona, entitled Lemelson
Medical, Education and Research Foundation LP v. Federal Express Corporation,
et.al., Cause No. CIV01-2287-PHX-PGR. The plaintiff claims that we and other
defendants have infringed 7 patents alleged to cover bar code technology. The
case seeks


A-40


16. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS AND CONTINGENCIES (CONTINUED)

unspecified damages, treble damages and injunctive relief. The Court has ordered
the case stayed pending the decision in a related case in which a number of bar
code equipment manufacturers have sought a declaration that the patents asserted
are invalid and unenforceable. That trial concluded in January 2003. In January
2004, the Court rendered its decision that the patents asserted by Lemelson were
found to be invalid and unenforceable. An appeal by Lemelson is expected and we
continue to dispute these claims and intend to defend this matter vigorously.

In October 2003, the Company settled the action brought against it by Chanin
Capital Partners LLC ("Chanin") on November 25, 2002 in the United States
District Court for the Southern District of Indiana Civil Action No.
1:02-CV-1834-JDT-WTL. Pursuant to the settlement the Company paid Chanin
$725,000 and the action was dismissed with prejudice. Net of amounts accrued in
2002, an additional $100,000 was recorded as a loss on debt extinguishment.

In September 2003, the Company settled the investigation of certain matters
including our accounting treatment of a certain contract entered into with an
insurance company conducted by the SEC. Pursuant to the settlement, the Company,
without admitting or denying any of the SEC's allegations, consented to the
entry of an administrative order to cease and desist from violations of the
anti-fraud, books and records, internal controls and periodic reporting
provisions of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and the anti-fraud provisions
of the Securities Act of 1933. The Company also paid a fine of $450,000 pursuant
to an order entered in the United States District Court for the Southern
District of New York.

17. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

The Company utilizes the services of a third party for the purchase of
corporate gifts, promotional items and standard personalized stationery. Mrs.
Judy Laikin, the mother of Robert J. Laikin, the Company's Chief Executive
Officer, was the owner of this third party until June 1, 2000 and is an
independent consultant to this third party. The Company purchased approximately
$63,321 and $91,382 of services and products from this third party during 2003
and 2002.

During the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003 the Company paid to an
insurance brokerage firm, for which the father of Robert J. Laikin acts as an
independent insurance broker, $225,415 in service fees and certain insurance
premiums, which premiums were forwarded to our respective insurance carriers.

The Company's Certificate of Incorporation and By-laws provide that it
indemnify its officers and directors to the extent permitted by law. In
connection therewith, the Company entered into indemnification agreements with
its executive officers and directors. In accordance with the terms of these
agreements the Company has reimbursed certain of its former executive officers
and intends to reimburse its officers and directors for their legal fees and
expenses incurred in connection with certain pending litigation and regulatory
matters. During 2003 and 2002, pursuant to their respective indemnification
agreements with Brightpoint, Inc., $26,606 and $93,280 in legal fees was paid on
behalf of Phillip Bounsall and $1,419 and $107,739 in legal fees was paid on
behalf of John Delaney.


A-41


18. SUBSEQUENT EVENT

On February 19, 2004, the Company's subsidiary, Brightpoint Holdings B.V.,
completed the sale of its 100% interest in Brightpoint (Ireland) Limited
("Brightpoint Ireland") to Celtic Telecom Consultants Ltd. Consideration for the
sale consisted of cash of approximately $1.5 million and deferred consideration
of approximately $400 thousand, which is expected to be received in March 2004.
The Company expects to record a loss in the range of $3.5 million to $4.5
million in the first quarter of 2004 relating to the sale and Brightpoint
Ireland's results of operations will be classified as a part of discontinued
operations in the Company's consolidated statement of operations. The expected
loss includes the non-cash write-off of approximately $1.5 million pertaining to
cumulative currency translation adjustments.


A-42


19. QUARTERLY RESULTS OF OPERATIONS (UNAUDITED)

The quarterly results of operations are as follows (in thousands, except per
share data):



2003 FIRST SECOND THIRD FOURTH
- ---- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------

REVENUE $ 340,190 $ 379,406 $ 533,706 $ 547,072
GROSS PROFIT 18,797 22,378 27,055 31,993
INCOME (LOSS) FROM CONTINUING
OPERATIONS (2,260) 3,754 5,046 6,415
NET INCOME (LOSS) (2,848) 4,317 4,844 5,416

BASIC PER SHARE:
INCOME (LOSS) FROM CONTINUING
OPERATIONS $ (0.13) $ 0.21 $ 0.28 $ 0.35
NET INCOME (LOSS) $ (0.16) $ 0.24 $ 0.27 $ 0.29

DILUTED PER SHARE:
INCOME (LOSS) FROM CONTINUING
OPERATIONS $ (0.12) $ 0.20 $ 0.27 $ 0.33
NET INCOME (LOSS) $ (0.15) $ 0.23 $ 0.26 $ 0.28




2002 First Second Third Fourth
- ---- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------

Revenue $ 295,107 $ 302,521 $ 336,761 $ 341,678
Gross profit 16,230 14,454 19,967 21,343
Income (loss) from continuing
operations (3,296) 2,436 11,121 3,543
Net income (loss) (47,952) (5,224) 9,494 1,261

Basic per share:
Income (loss) from continuing
operations $ (0.18) $ 0.14 $ 0.62 $ 0.20
Net income (loss) $ (2.67) $ (0.29) $ 0.53 $ 0.07

Diluted per share:
Income (loss) from continuing
operations $ (0.18) $ 0.14 $ 0.62 $ 0.20
Net income (loss) $ (2.67) $ (0.29) $ 0.53 $ 0.07


Note: Information in any one quarterly period should not be considered
indicative of annual results due to the effects of seasonality on the Company's
business in certain markets. The information presented above reflects:

o the effects of the 3 for 2 common stock splits on October 15, 2003 and
August 15, 2003 and the 1 for 7 reverse common stock split on June 27,
2002;

o the effects of the Richmond, California, facility consolidation charge
as more fully described in Note 2;

o the effects of divestitures and the related change in classification of
discontinued operations as more fully described in Note 7 to the
Consolidated Financial Statements;

o the cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle in the first
quarter of 2002 as more fully described in Note 1 to the Consolidated
Financial Statements;

o gains on the extinguishment of debt in the first quarter of 2001 and
the second, third and fourth quarters of 2002 as described in Note 3 to
the Consolidated Financial Statements;

o and a non-cash investment impairment charge in the third quarter of
2002 as described in Note 4 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.


A-43


MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF
OPERATIONS

EXECUTIVE OVERVIEW

Brightpoint is one of the largest dedicated distribution and logistics companies
in the global wireless industry. There are many large-scale competitors that
provide similar services for multiple industries, however, Brightpoint is one of
a few that specialize in the wireless industry and maintains logistics and
distribution services within the wireless industry as its core competency.

Brightpoint dedicates the majority of its resources to and generates the
majority of its revenues from the provision of distribution and logistics
services to customers in the global wireless industry. The primary source of
revenue is the handling of the wireless device through either the purchase and
resale of the wireless device (distribution) or through the handling of the
wireless device on behalf of network operators for a fee (logistics services).
The purchase and resale of the wireless device includes the value of the product
that generates a relatively higher revenue transaction per unit, while the
handling of the device on behalf of a network operator, who generally owns the
product, generates a relatively lower revenue transaction per unit in the form
of a fee. Therefore, our predominant source of revenue and related cost of
revenue is in the distribution of wireless devices, while the provision of
logistics services is a lesser source of revenue. In terms of total revenue in
2003, distribution represented 87% and logistics services represented 13%. In
terms of wireless devices handled in 2003, distribution represented 53% while
logistics services represented 47%. It is important to recognize that although
revenue related to logistics services is significantly lower than distribution
services, the investment in working capital and the risk related to working
capital is significantly lower. In addition to sales of wireless devices,
distribution revenue includes sales of wireless accessories. Included in
logistics services are an array of services that do not necessarily include the
handling of the wireless device. These include, but are not limited to, the
purchase and resale or the handling for a fee of prepaid wireless services
recharge cards, activation services, the handling of accessories, call center
services, and the provision of credit management services.

Our revenues are significantly influenced by growth in the total number of
wireless devices sold to subscribers globally by the entire industry. In 2003,
it is estimated that 471 million wireless devices were sold to subscribers. This
is up 18% from 2002. The total number of wireless devices handled by us grew by
34% from 2002. Our growth rate will be explained further in this section. In
prior years, the majority of wireless devices sold were to new subscribers as
wireless services proliferated throughout the world. Recently, the trend has
shifted more toward replacement wireless devices purchased by existing
subscribers. The limited operating life of wireless devices, combined with the
introduction of more fully-featured wireless devices by manufacturers and the
promotional activity of network operators to motivate subscribers to switch
networks or add services to subscriber plans, which generally require or include
a new wireless device, have been underlying causes for the shift to replacement
sales. Within the industry this trend is commonly referred to as the
"replacement cycle."

We are organized geographically where our operating divisions focus solely on
their respective geographies. Our divisions are: Asia-Pacific, the Americas, and
Europe, which are led by divisional presidents. We have 14 distribution centers
(three of which are outsourced to third parties) in 13 countries worldwide. As
of December 31, 2003, we had 1,153 employees and 407 full-time equivalent
temporary workers.


A-44



AREAS OF MANAGEMENT FOCUS

We focus a great deal of our time on growing the volume of wireless devices
handled. We are indifferent as to whether they are handled via distribution
sales or logistics services. Both channels generate operating margins for the
Company and we believe we currently have a diversified sales mix. Earning an
adequate gross margin on both sets of transactions is important to us. Improving
our operating efficiencies and consequently reducing our average cost per
transaction is essential to our profitability and prospects for earnings growth.
We measure our business entities by operating income growth, which incorporates
the elements described above.

Profitability in the context of capital efficiency is important to us. We
measure this concept with a metric entitled return on invested capital from
operations ("ROIC"). We look at our operating income from continuing operations,
excluding unusual items, such as the 2003 facility consolidation charges
incurred, and apply an estimated income tax rate and compare this net result to
a simple average of capital employed during the period. In our case, capital
employed is stockholders' equity and gross debt. Related to this view is cash
flow. Earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization ("EBITDA")
is how we measure our business' ability to generate cash. EBITDA is a non-GAAP
financial measure. Change in our cash conversion cycle is an indicator whether
we are increasing or decreasing our working capital excluding debt. In certain
instances, increases in our working capital excluding debt are contributory to
the success of the business; therefore, an increase in the cash conversion cycle
may not necessarily be a negative indicator. To position the Company for future
growth opportunities and to confront unanticipated adversity, we have been
highly focused on cash and borrowing availability. We utilize a metric we call
liquidity, which is the summation of unrestricted, and therefore available, cash
and unused borrowing availability. We are currently using a portion of our
liquidity to invest in India and are contemplating investing in other geographic
regions.

Management spends a significant amount of time traveling with the purpose of
spending time with key customers, suppliers, and employees. We believe that
these relationships are vital to the success of the Company and will continue to
dedicate a significant amount of time in this area.

Other areas that we focus on include management execution, quality, risk
management, employee development, legal and ethical compliance, and corporate
governance.

We believe the ultimate beneficiary of the areas of focus above is the
shareholder and we keep the shareholder at the forefront of our discussions and
decision-making.

KEY INDICATORS OF PERFORMANCE

Key indicators of performance for the Company, which are referred to further in
this discussion, include:

o Wireless devices handled

o Revenue growth

o Gross margin percent

o Selling, general and administrative expenses ("SG&A") as a percent of
revenue

o Operating income growth


A-45


o Cash conversion cycle, which includes days sales outstanding, days
inventory on-hand, and days payables outstanding

o Net cash provided by operating activities

o ROIC

o Liquidity

TRENDS, CHALLENGES, RISKS AND GROWTH OPPORTUNITIES

Wireless industry trends, challenges, risks and growth opportunities include:

o Maturation of the industry. It is estimated that there are 1.3 billion
wireless subscribers worldwide - an amount greater than wireline
subscribers. Penetration rates are as high as 83% in Western Europe and
69% in key Asian markets. In the United States, the penetration rate is
approximately 56%. Developing markets such as India, China, and Eastern
Europe still have relatively lower penetration rates, however, they are
growing rapidly. As global penetration rates increase, the wireless
device industry will rely more upon the replacement of wireless devices
by existing subscribers. The implications for the Company are that
replacement sales are becoming a more significant source of revenue.
The risks include the predictability of replacement cycles across
various markets. We believe that we are currently operating in an
environment of increasing replacement sales, which contributed to our
growth in 2003. There are no assurances this trend will continue in the
future.

o Recent growth in wireless device sales. In 2002, the wireless device
industry experienced a modest decline of less than 1%. In 2003,
wireless device sales grew by approximately 18% and current forecasts
by industry analysts expect growth rates of approximately 11%. A rapid
decline in wireless device sales growth could negatively impact the
Company's revenues. Higher than anticipated growth in demand could
strain our resources and affect our ability to meet unanticipated
demand.

o Availability of product and channel inventory. Early in 2003, the
effect of the SARS virus caused an oversupply of inventory, both
finished goods and raw materials, in the industry in Asia. This
modestly affected the Company in the first half of 2003. Excess supply
conditions can reduce the market price of the products we sell and
therefore affect our ability to generate sales, gross margins at
historical levels and could also affect the value of our inventory.
Conversely, in the second half of 2003, manufacturers were unable to
respond to an unanticipated increase in demand on a timely basis;
therefore, we, as well as others in the industry, experienced product
supply constraints that affected our ability to fully deliver products
that were requested by our customers. We are unable to quantify these
effects. It is difficult to predict demand patterns and supply
conditions, which can affect our ability to meet demand or sell
products at acceptable gross margins.

o Decline in average selling prices. It is estimated that the industry's
average selling price for wireless devices declines by approximately
10% to 15% per year. Although manufacturers have been adding features
and functionality to wireless devices to offset industry trends toward
average selling price erosion, we believe the trend of price declines
will continue. This can affect the Company's revenue since the average
selling price in conjunction with the volumes we sell are direct
components of our revenue. Product sales mix can affect our average
selling prices. Certain


A-46


markets where we operate in the Asia-Pacific division tend to demand
lower priced products and the higher growth rates we experienced in the
Asia-Pacific division have affected our consolidated average selling
prices for wireless devices.

Company specific trends, challenges, risks and growth opportunities include:

o Unit and revenue growth. In 2003, the Company experienced 34% growth in
wireless devices handled and 41% growth in revenue. Our growth in the
Asia-Pacific division and, to a lesser extent, in the Americas
division, were key contributors to the Company's overall growth.
Although we have incorporated growth elements in our strategy, we do
not anticipate growing our revenue at the same rate in future periods.

o Earnings growth. The Company incurred significant losses in 2001 and in
2002. The Company has established a recent trend, beginning in late
2002, of quarterly earnings growth and stability. Our strategy
incorporates growth elements for revenue and our operating plans
incorporate improvements in efficiencies, which we hope will result in
continued earnings growth. However, there can be no assurances this
trend will continue. As we may potentially invest in growth
opportunities in new markets and assume additional risks, our earnings
trend may alter.

o Reduction in our cash conversion cycle. We have reduced our average
annual cash conversion cycle from 20 days in 2001 to 12 days in 2002
and to 3 days in 2003. This was as a result of focus on managing our
balance sheet and cash balances. Historical high levels of debt and the
March 11, 2003 put option feature in our Convertible Notes necessitated
this level of focus. Positioning the Company for future growth
motivated us to pursue this trend. A cash conversion cycle of 3 days is
an unusually low number for a distribution company. As we may
potentially invest in future growth opportunities in new markets and
assume additional risks, the cash conversion cycle may increase.
Additionally, our performance in this area is dependent upon, but not
limited to, customer payment patterns, suppliers' terms and conditions,
our ability to manage our inventory, and our ability to sell accounts
receivables in certain markets.

o Net cash provided by operating activities. We have been able to
generate positive operating cash flow for 7 quarters in a row through
the fourth quarter of 2003. As we may potentially invest in growth
opportunities in new markets and assume additional risks, our cash flow
trends may alter.

o Reduction of Debt. We have reduced our total debt from $166 million in
2001 to $22 million in 2002 and to $16 million in 2003 as of December
31 of the respective years. A key metric of ours,
gross-debt-to-total-capitalization ratio, has reduced from 53% in 2001
to 16% in 2002 and to 10% in 2003, as measured by the December 31 dates
of the respective years. Currently, we do not anticipate a material
increase in our debt level, however, we would consider using debt to
finance growth opportunities.

o Improvements in ROIC from operations. In 2002, our ROIC was less than
1%. On a quarterly basis, we have been able to improve our annualized
quarterly ROIC in the fourth quarter of 2003 to 21% and for the full
year 2003 to 15%. This will continue to be a focus area for us;
however, there are no assurances this trend will continue.
Additionally, we have noticed seasonal patterns in annualized ROIC. In
the fourth quarter, we have historically been able to achieve a higher
level of


A-47


annualized ROIC; while in the first quarter, we have historically
achieved significantly lower results.

o Sales mix shift between product distribution and logistics services.
Over the past several years, we have been growing our fee-based
logistics services business such that it has become a significant
portion of our revenue generating activity. Our offering includes
services associated with wireless devices and non-wireless device
products such as accessories and prepaid recharge cards. A significant
portion of the activity in this business is the handling of wireless
devices. The revenue associated with the services related to wireless
devices generally excludes the value of the product and is in the form
of a fee that is generally less than $15 per unit. Distribution
revenue, on the other hand, includes the value of the product, which
had an average selling price of $137 per unit in 2003. We focus on the
handling of wireless devices regardless of whether they are handled as
a logistics service or a distribution sale. The disparity in revenue
per unit between a logistics service unit and a distribution sale unit
combined with shifts in sales mix have created sensitivity in
historical revenue patterns. When percentage unit sales mix has shifted
from fee-based logistics services toward product distribution sales, we
have seen higher percentage increases in revenue relative to the
increases in wireless devices handled. Conversely, when percentage unit
sales mix has shifted from product distribution sales toward fee-based
logistics services, we have seen lower percentage increases in revenue
relative to the increases in wireless devices handled. For this reason,
we place a high importance on total wireless devices handled in
measuring the growth of our business. In 2003, distribution represented
53% while logistics services represented 47% of wireless devices
handled. In terms of total revenue, distribution represented 87% and
logistics services represented 13%. Our total revenue grew by 41% in
2003 as compared to 2002, while the wireless devices handled grew by
34% in the same period. This difference in growth rates was influenced
by a sales mix shift toward product distribution. We expect this
sensitivity to continue in future periods and cannot provide
indications of expected trends toward logistics services or
distribution sales.

o The strengthening of foreign currencies relative to the U.S. dollar.
38% of our revenue in 2003 was denominated in foreign currencies. Our
total revenue in 2003 grew by 41% as compared to 2002. Seven percentage
points were attributable to the strengthening of foreign currencies
relative to the U.S. dollar. This effect had a favorable impact on our
operating income. Should the recent trends in currency exchange rates
take a reverse direction, the effect could be unfavorable to the
Company. Although we hedge transactional currency risk, we do not hedge
foreign currency revenue or operating income. We also do not hedge our
investment in foreign subsidiaries, where fluctuations in foreign
currency exchange rates may affect our comprehensive income or loss.

o Recent growth of our Brightpoint Asia Limited business. We have
experienced significant growth rates in our Brightpoint Asia Limited
business within the past two years. This business sells products to
exporters based in Hong Kong and Singapore. Variables that affect our
customers or suppliers, such as changes in import tariffs, duties, and
currency exchange rates, may adversely affect our operating results.
Additionally, our customers may find alternative sources of supply,
which may affect their purchasing patterns and have an adverse affect
on our operating results.

There are many inherent risks and challenges in the trends described above.
Also, please refer to the Business Risk Factors section. We plan on continuing
to focus on volume and revenue growth


A-48


opportunities, managing our gross margin and cost structure, and consequently,
potential growth in operating income. We plan on continuing to focus on capital
efficiency as measured by ROIC and the cash conversion cycle. Cash and cash flow
will continue to be a focus area for us. Additionally, we plan on continuing our
focus on customer, supplier, and employee relationships, management execution,
quality, risk management, employee development, legal and ethical compliance,
and corporate governance.

Potential growth opportunities include:

o Continued expansion in the India market

o Entry into certain European markets

o Gaining market share in existing markets through customer acquisition
and retention

o Acquisition of businesses in current markets

o Expansion of our product and service offerings

IMPACT OF INFLATION

For 2003, inflation did not have a significant impact on our overall operating
results.

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES

PRODUCT COSTS

We recognized $1.6 billion in product costs sold in 2003. On December 31, 2003,
we carried $109 million of inventory. Included in our inventory are estimates of
reductions of inventory value due to lower market prices than our original
purchase prices, estimates for excess inventory and obsolescence risks, supplier
incentives earned through purchases but unrealized pending the sale of the
related products and estimates for capitalized operating costs related to the
handling of inventory. As of December 31, 2003, our total inventory allowance
balance was $5.0 million and the total amount of capitalized operating costs
were $638 thousand. Included in our cost of goods sold are estimates of supplier
incentives associated with products sold, the changes in inventory allowance
accounts that result from the actual disposition of products during the period,
changes in the capitalization of operating costs, and estimates for freight
costs. These estimates are dependent upon monthly and quarterly processes we
undertake throughout our operations worldwide. Rapidly changing market
conditions may affect the market value of inventory that we have on hand.
Because we do not have complete knowledge of the projected disposition of
products either through sales to customers, returns to suppliers, or through
liquidators, actual results may vary from our estimates.

ALLOWANCES FOR UNCOLLECTIBLE ACCOUNTS AND RELATED PROVISIONS

We provide credit to certain customers in the ordinary course of business.
Through credit analysis processes, credit insurance, and letters of credit, we
try to mitigate the risk associated with providing credit. We are unable to
cover our risk entirely and are exposed to potential payment defaults by our
customers. We estimate the probable loss on specific accounts. As of December
31, 2003, the allowance for doubtful accounts totaled $7.7 million. Because we
do not have complete knowledge on the projected collectibility of amounts owed
to us by customers, actual results may vary from our estimates.


A-49


IMPAIRMENT LOSSES AND CUMULATIVE EFFECT OF CHANGE OF ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLE

In 2002, we recorded a $41 million charge related to the adoption of SFAS 142,
Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets. This required certain processes of
impairment testing, which relied upon our estimates of future cash flows of
investments. Each year we conduct impairment tests of those investments, which
include goodwill and intangibles that also utilize our estimates of future cash
flows. Actual results may vary from our estimates. Additionally, in 2002 we
recorded an $8.3 million impairment loss on a long-term investment for
preference shares that we own in a Hong-Kong based logistics and distribution
company, Chinatron. In accordance with SFAS 115, Accounting for Certain
Investments in Debt and Equity Securities, the Company designated the Chinatron
Class B Preference Shares as held-to-maturity. The carrying value was
approximately $2 million at December 31, 2003 and 2002. Management currently
estimates there was no gross unrealized holding gain on this security. The
actual economic value realized from this investment may vary from our estimates.

DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS

When we discontinue an operation, we estimate the net realizable value of the
operation's assets and estimate any additional liabilities, other than wind-down
costs, that result from the decision to discontinue. As we liquidate the assets,
the actual realizable amounts may be different from those originally estimated.
As we pay down liabilities, new and unforeseen claims may arise on the
discontinued legal entity.

DEFERRED TAXES AND EFFECTIVE TAX RATES

We estimate the effective tax rates and associated liabilities or assets for
each legal entity in accordance with FAS 109. We use tax-planning to minimize or
defer tax liabilities to future periods. In recording effective tax rates and
related liabilities and assets, we rely upon estimates, which are based upon our
interpretation of United States and local tax laws as they apply to our legal
entities and our overall tax structure. Audits by local tax jurisdictions,
including the United States Government, could yield different interpretations
from our own and cause the Company to owe more taxes than originally recorded.
We utilize experts in the various tax jurisdictions to evaluate our position and
to assist in our calculation of our tax expense and related liabilities.

For interim periods, we accrue our tax provision at the effective tax rate that
we expect for the full year. As the actual results from our various businesses
vary from our estimates earlier in the year, we adjust the succeeding interim
periods effective tax rates to reflect our best estimate for the year-to-date
results and for the full year. As part of the effective tax rate, if we
determine that a deferred tax asset arising from temporary differences is not
likely to be utilized, we will establish a valuation allowance against that
asset to record it at its expected realizable value.


A-50


RESULTS OF OPERATIONS - 2003 COMPARISON TO 2002

REVENUE AND WIRELESS DEVICES HANDLED

Wireless Devices Handled by Division:



(Amounts in 000s) YEAR ENDED
---------------------------------------------------------------- Change from
December 31, % of December 31, % of 2002 to
2003 Total 2002 Total 2003
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------

Asia-Pacific 6,940 34% 3,189 21% 118%
The Americas 12,403 61% 10,969 72% 13%
Europe 996 5% 993 7% --
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Total 20,339 100% 15,151 100% 34%
============ ============ ============ ============ ============


Wireless Devices Handled by Service Line:



(Amounts in 000s) YEAR ENDED
---------------------------------------------------------------- Change from
December 31, % of December 31, % of 2002 to
2003 Total 2002 Total 2003
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------

Sales of wireless devices 10,837 53% 7,150 47% 52%
Integrated logistics services 9,502 47% 8,001 53% 19%
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Total 20,339 100% 15,151 100% 34%
============ ============ ============ ============ ============


Worldwide shipments of wireless devices grew approximately 18% to 471 million
devices in 2003, according to industry analysts. The industry generally
experienced improving economic conditions worldwide as compared to 2002, which
was more noticeably felt in the second half of 2003. In conjunction with an
improved economic environment, wireless device manufacturers were active in
launching new products with added features and functionality such as color
screens, embedded cameras, music playback, video gaming, internet and e-mail
access, and generally improved appearance and ergonomics (commonly referred to
as form factors). In parallel, many network operators launched additional
services that utilized the added functionality of the wireless devices. Services
include multimedia messaging, which allows a subscriber to send a digital image
or digital video recording to another subscriber or an email address and access
to internet web sites. In 2003, network operators were active in promoting their
services and wireless device offerings. The three factors described above:
improving economic conditions, more fully-featured wireless devices, and network
operators' service offering expansion and related promotional activity have
motivated many subscribers to replace their aging wireless devices. Network
operators have also engaged in promotional activity to attract subscribers from
competing networks. In many markets, the act of switching networks by a
subscriber is generally accompanied with the acquisition of a new wireless
device. Emerging markets, such as India, where penetration rates have been
historically lower than industrialized markets, generally experienced high
growth rates in subscriber acquisition, which drove high growth rates in
wireless device sales. These events contributed to our growth in wireless
devices handled.

For the Company, wireless devices handled grew by 34% in 2003, as compared to
2002. Strong demand for our products and services in the Asia Pacific division,
combined with our entry into the India market in the third quarter of 2003, were
significant contributors to our growth. For the Asia-Pacific division, wireless
devices handled grew by 118%, as compared to 2002. The Americas division, which
handled 61% of the wireless devices for the Company in 2003, grew by 13%.
Network operator customers of our integrated logistics services business in the
U.S., particularly those that target the prepaid wireless


A-51


segment, experienced high levels of demand and consequently increased our
volumes as compared to 2002. These volumes were partially offset by reduced
sales in our U.S. distribution business, which was negatively impacted by a lack
of CDMA products available to us from our primary supplier. The Europe division
experienced no growth in wireless devices handled. Continued growth related to
our entry in the Norway market in 2002 was partially offset by a decline in
volume in the Ireland market. An exclusive agreement with a network operator in
Ireland expired and was not renewed in late 2002 and consequently we lost market
share to new entrants in a certain segment of the Ireland market.

We experienced higher growth rates in wireless devices handled in the second
half of 2003 as compared to the first half of 2003. The spread of the SARS virus
throughout the Asia-Pacific region modestly and negatively affected our
Asia-Pacific division; global uncertainty revolving around the Iraq War
negatively affected many markets; and a harsh winter in the U.S. and the lack of
CDMA products from a certain supplier negatively affected the Americas division.
All of these events, which did not prevail in the second half of 2003,
negatively affected our growth in wireless devices handled. In the first half of
2003, wireless devices grew by 12% over the same period in the prior year
(primarily the Asia-Pacific division) and in the second half of 2003, which
included our entry into the India market, wireless devices handled grew by 54%.
In the second half of 2003, many manufacturers were unable to respond to an
unanticipated increase in demand and therefore, we experienced supply
constraints for certain products. We are unable to quantify the effect of these
constraints on our business.

Revenue by Division:



(Amounts in 000s) YEAR ENDED
---------------------------------------------------------------- Change from
December 31, % of December 31, % of 2002 to
2003 Total 2002 Total 2003
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------

Asia-Pacific $ 995,798 55% $ 527,499 41% 89%
The Americas 469,618 26% 493,203 39% (5%)
Europe 334,958 19% 255,365 20% 31%
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Total $ 1,800,374 100% $ 1,276,067 100% 41%
============ ============ ============ ============ ============


Revenue by Service Line:



(Amounts in 000s) YEAR ENDED
---------------------------------------------------------------- Change from
December 31, % of December 31, % of 2002 to
2003 Total 2002 Total 2003
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------

Product distribution $ 1,573,500 87% $ 1,089,534 85% 44%
Integrated logistics services 226,874 13% 186,533 15% 22%
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Total $ 1,800,374 100% $ 1,276,067 100% 41%
============ ============ ============ ============ ============


Total revenue grew by 41%, which was driven by a 44% growth rate of wireless
devices sold through our distribution businesses. As discussed above, the
Asia-Pacific division, which is primarily composed of distribution businesses,
experienced significant growth in wireless devices handled and was a key
contributor to our revenue growth.

Product distribution revenue grew by 44%. Separating the effect of fluctuating
foreign currency exchange rates, the average selling price of wireless devices
sold through our distribution businesses declined by 4%. In local currency
terms, a 20% decline in the average selling price in the Asia-Pacific division,
primarily caused by the sale of low-end wireless devices in India, was partially
offset by 8% and 10% increases in average selling prices in the Americas and
Europe divisions, respectively. The high growth in


A-52


the Asia-Pacific division's wireless device sales minimized the effect the
decrease in average selling price had on product distribution revenue. The
increase in average selling price in the Americas division increased product
distribution revenue for wireless devices, despite a decline in wireless devices
sold. The shift of an accessory program for a key customer from product
distribution to fee-based logistics services reduced the Americas distribution
revenue by approximately $24 million, which contributed to the overall decline
in the Americas revenue in 2003. The Europe division's increase in average
selling price on flat wireless devices growth, combined with additional sales of
accessories, increased our total product distribution revenue. The increase in
average selling prices in the Americas and Europe divisions is due to the sale
of more fully-featured and functional wireless devices. The strengthening of
foreign currencies relative to the U.S. dollar, which primarily affected the
Europe division and to a lesser extent, the Asia-Pacific division, increased
average selling prices by 4%.

Logistics services revenue increased by 22%. An increase in the sales of prepaid
wireless airtime in Europe contributed to this increase. Although the Americas
division was able to increase its wireless devices handled through logistics
services by 21%, price reductions related to certain customers significantly
offset any notable revenue gains. As described above, network operator customers
in the U.S., particularly those that target the prepaid wireless segment,
experienced high levels of demand and consequently increased our volumes as
compared to 2002.

The effect of the strengthening of foreign currencies relative to the U.S.
dollar contributed to 7 percentage points of the 41% total revenue increase.
This effect accounted for 20 percentage points of the 31% revenue increase for
the Europe division and 8 percentage points of the 89% increase in the
Asia-Pacific Division.

GROSS PROFIT AND GROSS MARGIN

Gross Profit by Service Line:



(Amounts in 000s) YEAR ENDED
---------------------------------------------------------------- Change from
December 31, % of December 31, % of 2002 to
2003 Total 2002 Total 2003
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------

Product distribution $ 54,372 54% $ 29,316 41% 85%
Integrated logistics services 45,851 46% 42,678 59% 7%
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Total $ 100,223 100% $ 71,994 100% 39%
============ ============ ============ ============ ============


Gross Margin by Service Line:



YEAR ENDED
-------------------------------- Change from
(Amounts in 000s) December 31, December 31, 2002 to
2003 2002 2003
------------- ------------- -------------

Product distribution 3.5% 2.7% 0.8% points
Integrated logistics services 20.2% 22.9% (2.7)% points
------------- ------------- -------
Total 5.6% 5.6% 0.0% points
============= ============= =======


The 39% increase in gross profit is primarily attributable to a 34% increase in
wireless devices handled and a 41% increase in total revenue from 2002.

The Americas and Europe divisions improved their gross margin performance, which
was primarily in product distribution. These improvements were offset by the
weighting effect of the increased proportion


A-53


of total revenue of the Asia-Pacific division, which historically operated with
a relatively lower gross margin percent. In 2002, the Asia-Pacific division's
total revenue accounted for 41% of total revenue, while in 2003 the proportion
was 55%. Additionally, in 2003 the Asia-Pacific division entered into the India
market and sold significant volumes of low-end lower gross margin CDMA wireless
devices and experienced a general reduction in supplier incentives, which
reduced its gross margin and partially offset gross profit growth.

The 85% increase in gross profit related to product distribution revenue is
primarily attributable to a 52% increase in wireless devices handled and a 44%
increase in product distribution revenue from 2002. The higher rate of growth in
gross profit as compared to revenue is attributable to the 0.8 percentage point
improvement in gross margin. In 2002, demand was relatively low which induced
some pricing pressure for wireless devices, we incurred $3.6 million in
inventory valuation adjustments primarily related to writing down inventory to
its net realizable value in Germany and the U.S., and we recognized a $2.6
million loss related to a minimum purchase obligation to an accessories supplier
in the U.S. These unfavorable events or similar events of a material nature did
not occur in 2003. Additionally, an improved selling-price environment and
strengthened inventory controls contributed to our improved gross margin
performance in 2003.

The 7% increase in gross profit in logistics services is attributable to a 22%
increase in revenue, partially offset by a 2.7 percentage point decline in gross
margin. Although the Americas division was able to increase its wireless devices
handled through logistics services by 21%, price reductions related to certain
customers significantly offset gross profit increases related to volume. The
Americas division was able to reduce their operating costs to significantly
offset the price reductions. Additionally, in 2003 the Americas division
consolidated its Richmond, California, call center with its Plainfield, Indiana,
call center. By utilizing existing infrastructure in Plainfield, we originally
expected to realize pre-tax cost savings, beginning in the second quarter of
2003, of approximately $2.0 million to $2.5 million annually. We believe we have
met these expected cost savings.. The Europe division experienced a 39% increase
in the sale of prepaid wireless airtime, which contributed to the revenue and
gross profit increase in logistics services, however, due to its generally lower
gross margin as compared to other logistics services gross margins, it had an
unfavorable effect on the overall gross margin percent.

SELLING, GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE ("SG&A") EXPENSES



YEAR ENDED
------------------------------------ Change from
(Amounts in 000s) December 31, December 31, 2002 to
2003 2002 2003
------------ ------------ -------------

SG&A expenses $73,867 $71,247 4%
Percentage of revenue 4.1% 5.6% (1.5)% points


SG&A expenses increased 4% in 2003 in conjunction with a 41% increase in
revenue. Cost reduction action such as reductions in force, the consolidation of
corporate offices with our North America facility in Plainfield, Indiana, and
tight controls on spending helped contain our spending growth to 4%. The
reduction of accessory programs in our North America business where selling
commissions were paid to network operators on accessory sales through their
channels reduced SG&A expenses by approximately $3 million. Offsetting our
spending decreases were variable costs related to the revenue and operating
income increases, which included variable compensation expenses, travel and
entertainment, entry into the India market, and growth of our business in
Norway. The strengthening of foreign currencies relative to the U.S.


A-54

dollar had an estimated $3.8 million unfavorable effect on SG&A. In 2002, SG&A
expenses included $1.5 million in employee separation costs.

As a percent of revenue, SG&A expenses were reduced from 5.6% to 4.1%. The 41%
increase in revenue, combined with a 4% increase in SG&A expenses drove the
decrease.

FACILITY CONSOLIDATION CHARGE

During 2003, we consolidated our Richmond, California, call center operation
into our Plainfield, Indiana, facility to reduce costs and increase productivity
and profitability in our Americas division. We completed the consolidation of
the facility in April of 2003 and have been engaged in a search for a sub-lessee
of the premises. During 2003, the Company recorded a pre-tax charge of $5.5
million which includes approximately $3.8 million for the present value of
estimated lease costs, net of an anticipated sublease, non-cash losses on the
disposal of assets of approximately $1.1 million and severance and other costs
of approximately $600 thousand. By utilizing existing infrastructure in
Plainfield, we originally expected to realize pre-tax cost savings, beginning in
the second quarter of 2003, of approximately $2.0 million to $2.5 million
annually. We believe we have met these expected cost savings. In 2003, total
cash outflows relating to the charge were approximately $1.3 million. At this
time, the Company does not expect to incur significant additional costs related
to the facility consolidation. However, if the Company is unsuccessful in
terminating the liability, finding a sub-lessee or if the terms of any sublease
are less than the revised estimate, the Company may incur additional expenses.

OPERATING INCOME

Operating Income by Division:



(Amounts in 000s) YEAR ENDED
----------------------------------------------- Change from
December 31, % of December 31, % of 2002 to
2003 Total 2002 Total 2003
------------ ------- ------------ ------- -----------

Asia-Pacific $14,088 68% $ 6,465 N/M 118%
The Americas (1) 3,621 17% (2,030) N/M N/M
Europe 3,186 15% (3,688) N/M N/M
------- ------- ------- ------- -------
Total $20,895 100% $ 747 100% N/M
======= ======= ======= ======= =======


N/M: Not Meaningful

Operating Income as a Percent of Revenue by Division:



(Amounts in 000s) YEAR ENDED
----------------------------- Change from
December 31, December 31, 2002 to
2003 2002 2003
------------ ------------ -----------

Asia-Pacific 1.4% 1.2% 0.2% points
The Americas (1) 0.8% (0.4%) 1.2% points
Europe 1.0% (1.4%) 2.4% points
---- ---- ---
Total 1.2% 0.1% 1.1% points
=== ==== ===


(1) Includes a facility consolidation charge of $5.5 million.

Operating income grew substantially from 2002. Overall, the 39% increase in
gross profit from $72 million to $100 million primarily caused by a 41% increase
in revenue, coupled with limited growth in


A-55


SG&A expenses (4%) were the primary contributors to the increase. Facilities
consolidation charges of $5.5 million in the Americas division partially reduced
our growth in operating income.

The 89% growth in revenue in the Asia-Pacific division, partially offset by a
decline in gross margin, in conjunction with a reduction in SG&A expenses as a
percent of revenue were the primary drivers behind its operating income growth
of 118%. Strong demand for our products and services, combined with our entry
into India in the third quarter of 2003 were the principal causes for our
revenue growth. Gross margin declined in the Asia-Pacific division due to the
sale of significant volumes of low-end CDMA products in India and a general
reduction in suppler incentives.

Although the Americas division's revenue declined by 5%, a 21% increase in
wireless devices handled through fee-based logistics services, combined with
cost reduction action taken in 2002 and 2003 and improved product cost
management contributed to the $5.6 million improvement in operating income. The
$5.5 million facility consolidation charge related to the consolidation of its
Richmond, California, call center with its Plainfield, Indiana, call center
partially offset this improvement.

The Europe division experienced a 31% increase in revenue. The strengthening of
European currencies relative to the U.S. dollar contributed to 20 percentage
points of the revenue increase. Operating expenses, including cost of good sold,
were negatively affected by European currency rate movement. The net effect on
operating income was a benefit of approximate $1 million. In local currency
terms, revenue grew by 11%, which was derived from increased sales of prepaid
wireless airtime and a 10% increase in average selling prices for wireless
devices sold. In 2002, our Germany operation incurred significant losses related
to inventory write-downs and excessive cost structure. In 2003, our Germany
operation grew its revenue by 42%, significantly reduced its cost structure, and
generated an operating income in the fourth quarter of 2003. Operating losses
incurred by our Ireland operation partially offset the overall improvements in
operating income in our other European businesses. An exclusive agreement with a
network operator expired and was not renewed in late 2002, consequently, we lost
market share to new entrants in a certain segment of the Ireland market.

NET INTEREST EXPENSE

Net Interest Expense:



YEAR ENDED
------------------------------ Change from
(Amounts in 000s) December 31, December 31, 2002 to
2003 2002 2003
------------ ------------ -------------

Net interest expense $1,146 $5,899 (81%)
Percentage of revenue 0.1% 0.5% (0.4)% points




OUTSTANDING AT DECEMBER 31
----------------------------------
SUMMARY OF SHORT-TERM AND LONG-TERM DEBT 2003 2002 2001
- ---------------------------------------- -------- -------- --------

Lines of Credit - Asia-Pacific $ 16,171 $ 10,052 $ 4,440
- The Americas -- -- 24,160
- Europe 36 51 6,142
Convertible Notes -- 12,017 131,647
-------- -------- --------
Total $ 16,207 $ 22,120 $166,389
======== ======== ========


Net interest expense declined by $4.8 million, or 81%, from 2002. This reduction
is a result of the Company significantly reducing its overall debt. On December
31, 2001, the Company had $132 million


A-56


of accreted value in Convertible Notes outstanding and $34 million in other debt
for a total of $166 million in total debt. This total debt represented a
gross-debt-to-total-capitalization ratio of 53%. During 2002, the Company
generated $70 million in net cash from operating activities and used the
proceeds toward the repurchase $120 million of accreted value in Convertible
Notes for $75 million in cash and the reduction of other debt by $25 million.
Through the repurchase of the Convertible Notes, we realized a gain of $44
million, which is reported as a gain on the extinguishment of debt. These
repurchases were made during the second, third, and fourth quarters of 2002.
During 2003, we repurchased the remaining outstanding Convertible Notes ($12.0
million in accreted value) and increased our other debt from $10.1 million to
$16.2 million. Our total debt decreased from $22 million on December 31, 2002,
to $16.2 on December 31, 2003, representing a decrease in our
gross-debt-to-total-capitalization ratio from 16% to 10%.

IMPAIRMENT ON LONG-TERM INVESTMENT

In 2003, we incurred no impairment losses on our long-term investment. The
Company designated the Chinatron Class B Preference Shares as held-to-maturity.
The carrying value was approximately $2 million at December 31, 2003 and 2002.

During the second half of 2001, we experienced lower than desired operating
results and returns on invested capital in our Brightpoint China Limited
operation primarily due to: i) continuing migration of Brightpoint China's
business from Hong Kong to mainland China ii) continuing reliance on a single
supplier for products within China with no exclusive product lines and iii) the
level of invested capital required to conduct this business was substantial
considering the risk of operating in China. A number of alternatives were
considered with respect to decreasing our financial and economic exposure to the
China market and as a result, in January 2002, we formed a joint venture with
Chinatron through their purchase of a 50% interest in Brightpoint China Limited,
which was at the time our wholly-owned subsidiary. In this transaction, we
granted Chinatron the option to purchase an additional 30% interest in this
subsidiary. We received 6,414,607 Chinatron Class B Preference Shares with a
face value of $10 million convertible into 10% of the issued and outstanding
ordinary shares of Chinatron as consideration. At the formation of the joint
venture, Brightpoint China Limited had a net book value of $18.8 million. In
March of 2002, rather than exercising its option, Chinatron offered to purchase
our remaining interest in Brightpoint China Limited for 7,928,166 Chinatron
Class B Preference Shares with a face value of $11 million that were convertible
into 11% of the issued and outstanding ordinary shares in Chinatron. This
transaction closed in April 2002, bringing our aggregate holdings in Chinatron
to 14,342,773 Class B Preference Shares with an aggregate face value of $21
million that were convertible into 19.9% of the issued and outstanding ordinary
shares of Chinatron. The net book value of Brightpoint China Limited at the time
of the sale of remaining 50% interest in Brightpoint China Limited was $5.2
million. At the time of the formation of the joint venture, the Company was not
aware that the actual value of the Chinatron Class B Preference Shares was
significantly below the face value because the Company had not yet completed a
valuation of the shares.

When the Company's internal valuations and analyses were completed, we estimated
a fair market value of $10.3 million for our aggregate holdings of 14,342,773
Chinatron Class B Preference Shares with a face value of $21 million. As of June
30, 2002, we believed the Chinatron Class B Preference Shares continued to have
an estimated fair market value of approximately $10.3 million.


A-57


During the third quarter of 2002, Chinatron sought to raise additional capital
to fund its operations and meet its business objectives. In September and
October of 2002, because of our own liquidity constraints and to help Chinatron
secure funding from other parties, which we believed would improve Chinatron's
ability to honor its remaining debt obligations of the Chinatron Class B
Preference Shares owned by us, we waived our right to participate in these
capital-raising activities, waived our right to require Chinatron to redeem a
portion of the Class B Preference Shares and agreed to modify the conversion
ratio of the preference shares. Collectively, these actions reduced our
ownership interest in Chinatron from 19.9% to less than 1%. However, all other
rights of the Chinatron Class B Preference Shares, including our right to
require Chinatron to redeem all or a portion of the Chinatron Class B Preference
Shares under certain circumstances, remained.

As discussed in greater detail in Note 4 to the Consolidated Financial
Statements, we recorded a non-cash impairment charge during the third quarter of
2002 of $8.3 million relating to our investment in the Chinatron Class B
Preference Shares. Management is responsible for estimating the value of the
Chinatron Class B Preference Shares. In accordance with SFAS 115, Accounting for
Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities, the Company designated the
Chinatron Class B Preference Shares as held-to-maturity. The carrying value was
approximately $2 million at December 31, 2003 and 2002. Management currently
estimates there was no gross unrealized holding gain on this security. See Notes
4 and 7 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion of the
divestiture of Brightpoint China Limited and our Chinatron investment.

OTHER EXPENSES



YEAR ENDED
-------------------------- Change from
(Amounts in 000s) December 31, December 31, 2002 to
2003 2002 2003
------------ ------------ ------------

Other expenses $2,488 $1,936 28%
Percentage of revenue 0.1% 0.2% 0.1% points


Other expenses increased by $552 thousand, or 28%. This line item is composed of
the cost on the sale of certain receivables to financial institutions conducted
routinely throughout the year by certain subsidiaries, fines and penalties, and
other items that are not operating expenses. The cost on the sale of certain
receivables was $1.4 million and $1.9 million for 2003 and 2002, respectively.
Total receivables sold were $280 million and $218 million during 2003 and 2002,
respectively. Included in other expenses in 2003 was a $450 thousand fine paid
in connection with the Company's settlement with the SEC.

INCOME TAX EXPENSE



YEAR ENDED
--------------------------- Change from
(Amounts in 000s) December 31, December 31, 2002 to
2003 2002 2003
------------ ------------ ---------------

Income tax expense $3,965 $15,180 (74%)
Effective tax rate 23.5% 52.4% (28.9)% points


The effective tax rate for 2003 was 23.5%. This differs from the United States
Federal income tax rate of 35% due to a significant portion of the Company's
taxable income having been generated in jurisdictions, which have lower tax
rates. In 2003, the reduction in the effective tax rate was partially offset by
the recognition of valuation allowances for the tax benefit of net operating
losses for three subsidiaries whose


A-58


ability to realize the benefits of net operating losses is uncertain at this
time. This compares to an effective tax rate of 52% recorded in 2002. In 2002,
the Company incurred a $44.4 million gain on extinguishment of debt, which was
taxed at an effective income tax rate of 40%. The effective rate in 2002 was
also affected by non-deductible $8.3 million impairment loss on long-term
investment. The negative tax effects of the gain on debt extinguishment and the
impairment loss on long-term investment were partially offset by higher taxable
income in jurisdictions, which have lower tax rates.

INCOME FROM CONTINUING OPERATIONS



YEAR ENDED
---------------------------- Change from
(Amounts in 000s) December 31, December 31, 2002 to
2003 2002 2003
------------ ------------ -----------

Operating income $20,895 $ 747 N/M
Interest expense 1,146 5,899 (81%)
Loss (gain) on extinguishment of
debt 365 (44,378) N/M
Other expenses 2,488 1,936 28%
Impairment of loss on long-term
investment -- 8,305 (100%)
Income from continuing operations
before taxes 16,896 28,985 (42%)
Income tax expense 3,965 15,180 (74%)
Income (loss) from continuing
operations before minority
interest 12,931 13,805 (6%)
Income from continuing operations 12,955 13,805 (6%)
Diluted earnings per share $ 0.68 $ 0.77 (12%)


Income from continuing operations decreased by $850 thousand, or 6%, from $13.8
million in 2002. The decrease was primarily attributable to a $44 million gain
on extinguishment of debt related to the repurchase of Convertible Notes in
2002, partially offset by an $8.3 million impairment on long-term investment in
which both transactions did not occur in 2003. The decline in income from
continuing operations from 2002 was partially offset by a $20 million
improvement in operating income, a $4.8 million decrease in net interest expense
and a reduction in the effective tax rate from 52.4% to 23.5%. The improvement
in operating income was due to a 41% increase in revenue, a 39% increase in
gross profit, partially offset by a 4% increase in SG&A expenses and $5.5
million in facility consolidation charges.

On a diluted per share basis, income from continuing operations decreased by 12%
from 2002, as a result of a 6% decrease in income from continuing operations
coupled with the increase of outstanding shares due primarily to the exercise of
stock options in 2003.

DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS



YEAR ENDED
------------------------------- Change from
(Amounts in 000s) December 31, December 31, 2002 to
2003 2002 2003
------------ ------------ -----------

Loss from discontinued operations $ 698 $ 12,861 N/M
Loss on disposal of discontinued operations 528 2,617 (79%)
------- --------
Total discontinued operations $ 1,226 $ 15,478 N/M
------- --------

Percentage of Revenue N/M 1.2% N/M


Loss from discontinued operations in 2003 was $1.2 million, or $0.06 per diluted
share, compared to $15.5 million, or $0.86 per diluted share, in 2002. The loss
from discontinued operations in 2002 was primarily


A-59


due to the sale of the Company's operations in China, the Middle East and
Mexico. The loss from discontinued operations in 2003 was primarily due to
unrealized foreign currency translation losses caused by the strengthening of
foreign currencies relative to the U.S. dollar and costs incurred in connection
with the liquidation of discontinued operations, offset by the receipt of
contingent consideration relating to the divestiture of the Company's Middle
East operations.

Our decisions to exit certain markets were based upon historical and projected
profitability, historical and projected return on invested capital, the
economic, legal, and regulatory environment and other factors. We plan on
continuing to evaluate non-performing businesses and may restructure those
businesses or exit the markets in which they operate. We have been successful at
restructuring certain non-performing businesses and have made decisions to
remain in certain markets due to the improved financial performance and
prospects for continual improvement.

NET INCOME



YEAR ENDED
-------------------------------------- Change from
(Amounts in 000s) December 31, December 31, 2002 to
2003 2002 2003
------------ ------------ ------------

Net income (loss) $11,729 $(42,421) N/M
Percentage of revenue 0.7% (3.3)% 4.0% points


Net income was $11.7 million, as compared to a net loss of $42 million in 2002.
This improvement in net income was primarily due to a cumulative effect of a
change of accounting principle related to the implementation of SFAS 142,
Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets, in 2002 which did not occur in 2003 and a
reduction in the loss in discontinued operations from $15.5 million to $1.2
million. The improvement in net income was also aided by a $20 million
improvement in operating income (primarily caused by a 41% increase in revenue,
an associated 39% increase in gross profit, which was partially offset by a 4%
increase in SG&A expenses and a $5.5 million in facility consolidation charge),
a $4.8 million decrease in net interest expenses, an $8.3 million impairment
loss on investment in 2002 that did not recur in 2003, and a reduction in the
effective tax rate in continuing operations from 52.4% to 23.5%. These items
substantially offset a $44 million gain in debt extinguishment in 2002 that did
not recur in 2003.

On a diluted per share basis, net income of $0.62 improved from a net loss of
$2.35. The exercise of stock options in 2003 had a 5% dilutive effect on
weighted average shares outstanding in 2003.


A-60


RETURN ON INVESTED CAPITAL FROM OPERATIONS, LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

RETURN ON INVESTED CAPITAL FROM OPERATIONS (ROIC)

We believe that it is equally important for a business to manage its balance
sheet as it does its statement of operations. A measurement that ties the
statement of operation performance with the balance sheet performance is Return
on Invested Capital from Operations, or ROIC. We believe if we are able to grow
our earnings while minimizing the use of invested capital, we will be optimizing
shareholder value and concurrently preserving resources in preparation for
further potential growth opportunities. We take a simplistic approach in
calculating ROIC: we apply an estimated average tax rate to the operating income
of our continuing operations with adjustments for unusual items, such as
facility consolidation charges, and apply this tax-adjusted operating income to
our average capital base, which, in our case, is our stockholders' equity and
debt. The details of this measurement for 2003 and 2002 are outlined below.



YEAR ENDED
DECEMBER 31,
-------------------------
(Amounts in 000s) 2003 2002
--------- ---------

Operating income after taxes:
Operating income from continuing operations $ 20,895 $ 747
Plus: facility consolidation charge 5,461 --
Less: estimated income taxes (1) (6,062) (391)
--------- ---------
Operating income after taxes $ 20,294 $ 356
========= =========

Invested capital:
Debt $ 16,207 $ 22,120
Stockholders' equity 147,584 113,643
--------- ---------
Invested capital $ 163,791 $ 135,763
========= =========

Average invested capital (2) $ 137,463 $ 215,432
========= =========

ROIC (3) 15% *
========= =========


* Less than 1%

(1) Estimated income taxes were calculated by multiplying the sum of
operating income from continuing operations and the facility
consolidation charge by the respective periods' effective tax rate.

(2) Average invested capital for annual periods represents the simple
average of the invested capital amounts for the prior year end and at
each quarter end in the respective annual period.

(3) ROIC is calculated by dividing operating income after taxes by average
invested capital.

Our ROIC in 2003 was approximately 15%, up from less than 1% for 2002. The
primary causes for the improvement was the $20 million improvement in operating
income in conjunction with a significant reduction of debt. On December 31,
2001, the Company had $132 million of accreted value in Convertible Notes
outstanding and $35 million in other debt for a total of $166 million in total
debt. This total debt represented a gross-debt-to-total-capitalization ratio of
53%. During 2002, we generated $70 million in net cash from operating activities
and used the proceeds toward the repurchase of $120 million in accreted value
Convertible Notes for $75 million in cash and reduced other debt by $25 million.
These repurchases were made during the second, third, and fourth quarters of
2002 and consequently the benefits of the reduced debt were more notable in the
second half of 2002. During 2003, we repurchased the remaining outstanding
Convertible Notes ($12.0 million in accreted value) and increased our other debt
from $10.1 million to $16.2 million. Our total debt decreased from $22 million
on December 31, 2002, to $16.2 on


A-61

December 31, 2003, representing a decrease in our gross-debt-to-total-
capitalization ratio from 16% to 10%. Since the Company has earned income in
2003, increased its common stock and additional paid-in capital through the
exercise of employee stock options, and experienced a reduction in accumulated
other comprehensive loss due to the general strengthening of foreign currencies
relative to the U.S. dollar, the equity component in this calculation has
increased from $114 million as of December 31, 2002, to $148 million as of
December 31, 2003, and has therefore added to our invested capital base.

CASH CONVERSION CYCLE



THREE MONTHS ENDED YEAR ENDED
DECEMBER 31, DECEMBER 31,
------------------ ------------------
2003 2002 2003 2002
---- ---- ---- ----

Days sales outstanding in accounts receivable 20 28 25 30
Days inventory on-hand 20 22 24 24
Days payable outstanding (37) (39) (46) (42)
--- --- --- ---
Cash conversion cycle days 3 11 3 12
=== === === ===


A key source of our liquidity is our ability to invest in inventory, sell the
inventory to our customers, pay our suppliers and collect cash from our
customers. We refer to this as the cash conversion cycle. The cash conversion
cycle is measured by the number of days it takes to effect the cycle of
investing in inventory, selling the inventory, paying suppliers and collecting
cash from customers. The components in the cash conversion cycle are days of
sales outstanding in accounts receivable, days of inventory on hand, and days of
payables outstanding. The cash conversion cycle, as we measure it, is the
netting of days of sales outstanding in accounts receivable and days of
inventory on hand with the days of payable outstanding. Circumstances when the
cash conversion cycle decreases generally generate cash for the Company.
Conversely, circumstances when the cash conversion cycle increases generally
consume cash in the form of additional investment in working capital. During
2003, the cash conversion cycle decreased to 3 days from 12 days in 2002, which
was a key source of cash for the Company. The 41% growth in revenue in 2003 as
compared to 2002 increased the amount of cash associated with each cash
conversion cycle day; therefore, 3 cash conversion cycle days in 2003
represented a higher investment in working capital than in 2002. This effect
partially offset the cash generated by reducing the cash conversion cycle from
12 days in 2002 to 3 days in 2003. Three days is an unusually low number for a
distribution company and it is unlikely that we can sustain this short cycle for
an extended period of time. Increases in the cash conversion cycle would have
the effect of consuming our cash, causing us to borrow from lenders or issuing
stockholders' equity to fund the related increase in working capital. Our
potential investments in new markets may cause us to increase our inventory
levels in conditions where our customer base is relatively new and whose
purchasing behavior is less predictable. This situation can have the effect of
increasing our cash conversion cycle and consequently consume our cash or
increase our debt levels.

The Company was able to attain days of sales outstanding of 25 days by
collecting cash prior to product delivery from certain customers, selling
receivables in certain markets and therefore collecting cash prior to the
customer invoice due dates, focusing on credit and collections, and offering
customers early-pay discounts. The Company was able to attain days of inventory
on hand of 24 days by monitoring our inventory levels very closely and
consciously striving to keep our investment low while still holding enough
inventory to meet customer demand. Our improving financial condition in 2003
caused suppliers to relax their credit standards and we were able to obtain
higher credit limits and longer payment requirements. This has enabled to us to
pay suppliers in 46 days on average. From time to time, we may


A-62


accept suppliers' offers of early settlement discounts and may pay our suppliers
prior to the invoice due date. This may consume our cash or may cause us to
borrow from lenders.

The detail calculation of the components of the cash conversion cycle is as
follows:

(A) Days sales outstanding in accounts receivable = Period end accounts
receivable for continuing operations divided by average daily revenue
(inclusive of value-added taxes for foreign operations) for the period.

(B) Days inventory on-hand = Period end inventory for continuing operations
divided by average daily cost of revenue (excluding indirect product and
service costs) for the period.

(C) Days payables outstanding = Period end accounts payable for continuing
operations divided by average daily cost of revenue (excluding indirect
product and service costs) for the period.



(Amounts in 000s) Year ended December 31,
---------------------------------------------
DAYS SALES OUTSTANDING IN ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE: 2003 2002 2001
----------- ----------- -----------

Continuing operations revenue $ 1,800,374 $ 1,276,037 $ 1,263,700
Value-added taxes invoiced for continuing operations 120,448 71,166 64,435
----------- ----------- -----------
Total continuing operations revenue and value-added taxes 1,920,822 1,347,233 1,328,135

Daily sales including value-added taxes 5,336 3,742 3,689

Ending accounts receivable (including value-added taxes) 132,944 111,771 184,567
Exclude discontinued operations -- -- (37,734)
----------- ----------- -----------
Continuing operations ending accounts receivable $ 132,944 $ 111,771 $ 146,832
Days sales outstanding in Accounts Receivable (A) 25 30 40
=========== =========== ===========

DAYS INVENTORY ON-HAND
Continuing operations cost of revenue $ 1,700,151 $ 1,204,073 $ 1,189,925
Indirect product and service costs (91,019) (91,182) (84,906)
----------- ----------- -----------
Total continuing operations cost of products sold 1,609,132 1,112,891 1,105,019

Daily cost of products sold 4,470 3,091 3,070

Ending inventory 108,665 73,472 137,549
Exclude discontinued operations -- -- (21,170)
----------- ----------- -----------
Continuing operations ending inventory $ 108,665 $ 73,472 $ 116,379
Days inventory on-hand (B) 24 24 38
=========== =========== ===========

DAYS PAYABLES OUTSTANDING IN ACCOUNTS PAYABLE
Daily cost of products sold $ 4,470 $ 3,091 $ 3,070

Ending accounts payable 204,242 129,621 196,938
Exclude discontinued operations (59) (251) (17,589)
----------- ----------- -----------
Continuing operations ending account payable $ 204,183 $ 129,370 $ 179,349
Days payable outstanding (C) 46 42 58
=========== =========== ===========
Cash conversion cycle days (A+B-C) 3 12 20
=========== =========== ===========



A-63


CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

We use the indirect method of preparing and presenting our statements of cash
flows. In our opinion, it is more practical than the direct method and provides
the reader with a good perspective and analysis of the Company's cash flows.

NET CASH PROVIDED BY OPERATING ACTIVITIES

Net cash provided by operating activities was $56 million. Our primary sources
of cash in 2003 were the improvement in the cash conversion cycle as described
above and the cash generated by operations as measured by earnings before
interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization ("EBITDA"). Since the Company has
experienced cash outlays for interest and taxes and has experienced cash inflows
and outflows related to changes in working capital, EBITDA is not a
comprehensive measure of cash flow. It is an indicator, however, of the
business' ability to generate cash by maintaining revenues and related margins
at a higher level than cash operating expenses. Note that EBITDA is a non-GAAP
financial measure. During the 2003, the Company generated an EBITDA of
approximately $30 million as calculated below:


YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
(Amounts in 000s) 2003 2002
-------- ---------

Net income (loss) $ 11,729 $(42,421)
Net interest expense 1,146 5,899
Income taxes (includes income taxes included
in Discontinued Operations) 4,129 (6,000)
Depreciation and amortization 12,733 12,431
-------- --------
EBITDA $ 29,737 $(30,091)
======== ========


The significant items within the adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to
net cash provided by operating activities include:



YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
-----------------------
(Amounts in 000s) 2003 2002
-------- ---------

Net income (loss) $ 11,729 $(42,421)
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash
provided by operating activities:
Depreciation and amortization 12,733 12,431
Facility consolidation charge 5,461 --
Change in deferred taxes 2,010 12,852
Discontinued operations 1,226 15,478
Net cash used by discontinued operations (793) (8,517)
Gain (loss) on debt extinguishment 365 (44,378)
Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of
tax -- 40,748
Impairment loss on long-term investment -- 8,305
Other (1,806) 5,632
Changes in operating assets and
liabilities, net of effects from acquisitions and
divestitures:
Accounts receivable (4,306) 70,068
Inventories (27,575) 53,888
Other operating assets 806 17,450
Accounts payable and accrued expenses 55,677 (71,415)
-------- --------
Net cash provided by operating activities $ 55,527 $ 70,121
======== ========



A-64


Depreciation and amortization was slightly higher in 2003 as compared to 2002.
Our capital expenditure trends have been declining since 2001 and consequently
depreciation and amortization related to these expenditures have flattened out.
Capital expenditures were $6.1 million, $8.7 million, and $27 million for 2003,
2002, and 2001, respectively. In 2003, the Company recorded $5.5 million in
facility consolidation charges. $1.1 million was related to the write-down of
fixed assets, $600 thousand were cash expenses related to the severance of
employees and other consolidation costs, and $3.8 million was related to the net
present value of the lease payments less an estimate for sublease income which
we expect to generate net cash outflows of $2.8 million through 2009. Cash
outflows related to the Richmond, California, facility and its consolidation
with the Plainfield, Indiana, facility were $971 thousand in 2003. In 2003, the
$2.0 million change in net deferred income taxes was a result of temporary
differences between the provision and payments of income taxes. In 2002, the
$12.9 million change in deferred income taxes was due to the utilization of net
operating loss carryforwards and other temporary differences. Discontinued
operations of $1.2 million and $15.5 million for 2003 and 2002, respectively,
are disclosed as adjustments and the cash utilized of $800 thousand and $8.5
million for 2003 and 2002, respectively, are separately identified. In 2003, the
Company experienced a slight loss on debt extinguishment of $365 thousand in
connection with the repurchases of the Convertible Notes. This compares to a
gain of $44 million in 2002 where $120 million in accreted value of Convertible
Notes were repurchased for $75 million in cash. Since this gain was non-cash in
nature, other than the funds utilized to repurchase the Convertible Notes as
presented in the Financing Activities section of the Statement of Cash Flows, it
is classified as an adjustment to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash
provided by operating activities. In 2002, the Company adopted SFAS 142,
Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets, and incurred a non-cash charge of $41
million. This type of event did not recur in 2003. In 2002, the Company recorded
a non-cash investment impairment charge of $8.3 million related to $21 million
in face value preference shares for Chinatron Limited, a Hong Kong based
distribution and logistics company. This type of event did not recur in 2003.

The net changes in operating assets and liabilities were $25 million in 2003 and
$70 million in 2002. The effect in 2003 was primarily related to the improvement
in the cash conversion cycle from 12 days in 2002 to 3 days in 2003 as discussed
above. The cash conversion cycle improved in 2002 from 20 days in 2001 to 12
days. This contributed to the positive changes in operating assets and
liabilities in 2002.

INVESTING ACTIVITIES



YEAR ENDED
DECEMBER 31
(Amounts in 000s) 2003 2002
------- -------

Capital expenditures $(6,057) $(8,671)
Purchase acquisitions, net of cash acquired (2,880) --
Cash effect of divestiture 1,328 (6,307)
Decrease in funded contract financing receivables 5,887 20,750
Other 154 2,927
------- -------
Net cash provided (used) by investing activities $(1,568) $ 8,699
======= =======


Investing activities are primarily composed of $6.1 million in capital
expenditures and a $5.9 million decrease in funded contract financing
receivables. Capital expenditures were primarily directed toward improving our
information systems, particularly in the United States, our entry into India,
which included new office space and basic information systems infrastructure.
This was down 30% from 2002 when we


A-65


invested $8.7 million in capital expenditures. A significant portion of our
investment in capital expenditures in 2002 was directed to an information
systems implementation in the United States, which was initiated in 2001. The
Company experienced a decrease in funded contract financing receivables, which
had the effect of contributing $5.9 million to our cash flow. Included in
investing activities was $2.9 million in purchase acquisitions, which was
primarily composed of the purchase of retail outlets in France.

FINANCING ACTIVITIES



YEAR ENDED
DECEMBER 31
(Amounts in 000s) 2003 2002
------- -------

Net proceeds (payments) on credit facilities 2,761 (18,436)
Restricted cash requirements (5,000) --
Repurchase of convertible notes (11,980) (75,015)
Proceeds from common stock issuances under employee stock
option and purchase plans 12,383 173
------- -------
Net cash used by financing activities (1,836) (93,278)
======= =======


Net financing activities consumed $1.8 million of the Company's cash. The
Company pledged $5 million to support a $4.2 million short-term line of credit
in India primarily due to restrictions on foreign capital, which precluded us
from utilizing our own funds, other than the amount pledged, to meet these
needs. We may from time to time pledge cash to collateralize lines of credit in
markets where there are restrictions of the movement of funds. In the first and
second quarters of 2003, we repurchased approximately $12.0 million in accreted
value of Convertible Notes for $12.0 million in cash. This was funded from
working capital. The Convertible Notes were repurchased in full; therefore,
there will be no further use of cash to conduct any further repurchases. During
the year, 1.2 million stock options were exercised at an average strike price of
$10.27 per share. The proceeds to the Company in connection with these exercises
were $12.4 million.

The strengthening of foreign currencies relative to the U.S. dollar increased
our reported cash by approximately $3.0 million.

LINES OF CREDIT

The table below summarizes lines of credit that were available to the Company as
of December 31, 2003:



(Amounts in 000s) Letters of Credit Net
Commitment Gross Availability Outstanding & Guarantees Availability
---------- ------------------ ----------- ----------------- ------------

North America $ 70,000 $ 31,806 $ -- $ 5,200 $ 26,606
Australia 37,600 29,166 11,925 3,884 13,357
New Zealand 7,867 5,511 -- 4,000 1,511
India 4,246 4,246 4,246 -- --
Sweden 2,087 2,087 -- -- 2,087
Philippines 1,801 1,801 -- -- 1,801
Other -- -- 36 -- --
-------- -------- -------- -------- --------
Total $123,601 $ 74,617 $ 16,207 $ 13,084 $ 45,362
======== ======== ======== ======== ========


Additional details on the above lines of credit are disclosed in Note 12 of the
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.


A-66


We prefer our subsidiaries to open local lines of credit to support their
borrowing needs. For subsidiaries where we do not have local lending
relationships, we use our foreign finance subsidiary, Brightpoint Holdings B.V.,
to act as a lender through intercompany loans. Our foreign finance subsidiary
funds a significant portion of its intercompany loans through deposits from
certain subsidiaries, which have generated excess cash. There are circumstances
where subsidiaries utilize both local lenders and our foreign finance
subsidiary. We plan on continuing our pursuit of third party lending
relationships in the countries where our subsidiaries conduct business.

Brightpoint North America L.P. entered into an agreement with GE Capital in
2001, which has been amended periodically as circumstances warranted changes to
the agreement. Management believes these amendments have generally been
favorable to the Company. We believe that we have developed a good relationship
with GE Commercial Finance, which has led to the inception of facilities in
Australia in 2002 and New Zealand in 2003. We believe we gain cross-border
synergies by dealing with GE Commercial Finance globally and plan on continuing
to consider GE Commercial Finance as a lender in any market where both companies
operate.

Our financial condition has improved significantly since 2001. Our debt
structure as measured by gross-debt-to-total-capitalization ratio has dropped
from 53% in 2001 to 10% in 2003. Our cash conversion cycle has dropped from 20
days in 2001 to 3 days in 2003. This is indicative of improved management of key
balance sheet accounts such as accounts receivable, inventory, and accounts
payable. Through the fourth quarter ending December 31, 2003, we have been able
to generate net cash from operating activities for 7 consecutive quarters and
have developed more predictable patterns in our profitability. These factors,
among others, have improved our risk profile in the eyes of current and
potential lenders. As a result, we expect to be able to acquire better terms and
conditions from current or potential lenders than what was available as of
December 31, 2003 and prior periods, which consequently may reduce our cost of
capital.

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS - ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLES TRANSFERS

During the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002, the Company entered into
certain transactions or agreements with banks and other third-party financing
organizations in Ireland, Norway, Sweden, Australia, Mexico and France with
respect to the sale of a portion of its accounts receivable in order to reduce
the amount of working capital required to fund such receivables. These
transactions have been treated as sales pursuant to current accounting
principles generally accepted in the United States and, accordingly, are
accounted for as off-balance sheet arrangements. In certain markets, the Company
has greater access to financing through accounts receivable transfer
arrangements. As we enter into new markets or as lending relationships change
over time, we plan on evaluating both lines of credit and accounts receivable
transfer arrangements as sources of financing for the Company. We do not have a
preference of either alternative and consider the availability, costs, and
quality of financial institutions in making our determination of the optimal
source of financing.

Net funds received from the sales of accounts receivable during the years ended
December 31, 2003 and 2002 totaled $279 million and $216 million, respectively.
Fees, in the form of discounts, incurred in connection with these sales totaled
$1.4 million and $1.9 million during 2003 and 2002, respectively, and were
recorded as losses on the sale of assets. Approximately $1.4 million and $1.2
million in 2003 and 2002, respectively, relate to continuing operations and are
included as a component of "Other expenses" in the Consolidated Statements of
Operations. The remainder of the fees in 2002 were related to our former


A-67


Mexico operations and were included in net loss from discontinued operations in
the Consolidated Statements of Operations.

The Company is the collection agent on behalf of the third-party financing
organization for many of these arrangements and has no significant retained
interests or servicing liabilities related to accounts receivable that it has
sold. In certain circumstances, the Company may be required to repurchase the
corresponding accounts receivable sold, including, but not limited to, accounts
receivable in dispute or otherwise not collectible, credit insurance is not
maintained, a violation of, the expiration or early termination of the agreement
pursuant to which these arrangements are conducted. During 2003 and 2002, as a
result of the recourse arrangements, the Company repurchased approximately $234
thousand and $1.1 million of receivables, respectively, from banks or other
third party financing institutions. These agreements require the Company's
subsidiaries to provide collateral in the form of pledged assets and/or, in
certain situations, a guarantee by the Company of its subsidiaries obligations.

Pursuant to these arrangements, approximately $46 million and $30 million of
trade accounts receivable were sold to and held by banks and other third-party
financing institutions at December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively. Amounts held
by banks or other financing institutions at December 31, 2003 were for
transactions related to our Ireland, France, Norway and Sweden arrangements. All
other arrangements have been terminated or allowed to expire in 2002.

CAPITAL RESOURCES

Capital expenditures were $6.1 million, $8.7 million, and $27 million for 2003,
2002, and 2001, respectively. Capital expenditures were primarily directed
toward improving our information systems, particularly in the U.S., and our
entry into India, which included new office space and basic information systems
infrastructure. Expenditures for capital resources historically have been
generally composed of information systems, including upgrades and improvements,
leasehold improvements for warehouse, office, and retail facilities, and
warehouse equipment. We expect this pattern to continue in future periods. We
expect to invest in a range of $8 million to $12 million in 2004. A key
component of our strategic plan is geographic expansion. We expect our level of
capital expenditures to be affected by our geographic expansion activity.
Additionally, our U.S. subsidiary, Brightpoint North America L.P., plans on
continuing on an information systems implementation plan it initiated in 2001.

On October 31, 2003, the Company sold 15% of its interest in Brightpoint India
Private Limited to Persequor Limited ("Persequor") in exchange for a management
services agreement, in which Persequor will provide management services to
Brightpoint India Limited for five years (ending October 31, 2008). On the
fourth anniversary of the effective date and annually thereafter, Persequor has
a right to require Brightpoint Holdings B.V. to purchase Persequor's interest in
Brightpoint India Private Limited at a price determined by an appraisal method
as defined in the shareholders' agreement. Termination of the shareholders'
agreement is the earlier of (i) the date on which each of the Investors agree in
writing or (ii) the tenth anniversary of the Effective Date. Upon termination,
Brightpoint India Limited becomes owned by its shareholders and is no longer
subject to a shareholders' agreement. As a result, there are no options or puts
subsequent to termination. As of December 31, 2003, due to the relatively low
capitalization of Brightpoint India Private Ltd and to operating losses related
to start-up costs, we estimate the value of the put option is currently
negligible. We may incur costs and liabilities if the value of the put option
increases over the period of the shareholders' agreement. To the extent a
liability is recorded, representing the fair


A-68


value of the put option in excess of the amount of minority interest recorded,
the associated charge will be reflected as a reduction of net income to arrive
at income available to common shareholders.

The minority interest of Brightpoint India Private Limited's profit (loss) is
calculated and recorded monthly. At no time will the minority interest on the
balance sheet be less than zero. The Company is assumed to be responsible for
all losses in excess of the minority's interest. When profits recover the excess
losses absorbed by the Company, minority interest will be recorded
proportionately.

LIQUIDITY ANALYSIS

We measure liquidity in a certain way and use this measurement as an indicator
of how much access to cash we have to either grow the business through
investment in new markets, acquisitions, or through expansion of existing
service or product lines or to contend with adversity such as unforeseen
operating losses potentially caused by reduced demand for our products and
services, a material uncollectible accounts receivable, or a material inventory
write-down, as examples. Our measurement for liquidity is the summation of total
unrestricted cash and unused borrowing availability. The table below shows this
calculation.



December 31,
(Amounts in 000s) 2003 2002 % Change
-------- -------- --------

Unrestricted cash $ 98,879 $ 43,798 125%
Borrowing availability 45,362 41,920 8%
-------- -------- --------
Liquidity $144,241 $ 85,718 68%
======== ======== ========


As of December 31, 2003, our liquidity was $144 million, which was up 68% from
December 31, 2002. Cash increased by 125% while borrowing availability increased
by 8%. Our net cash provided by operating activities of $56 million in 2003 was
the primary contributor to the increase in liquidity. Our borrowing availability
increased as a result of the addition of new credit facilities in New Zealand
and the Philippines and the increase in our eligible assets in Australia and the
U.S., partially offset by a higher aggregate loan balance outstanding and the
issuance of letters of credit.

We routinely make large payments, in certain occasions in excess of $10 million,
to suppliers and routinely collect large payments from customers, in certain
occasions in excess of $10 million. The timing of these payments or collections
can cause our cash balances and borrowings to fluctuate throughout the year.

It is difficult to quantify the adequacy of our liquidity as indicated per our
measurement. As can be seen by the improvement in liquidity from December 31,
2002, we believe that our position has strengthened. Our cash balance as of
December 31, 2003 was $99 million. With an unused borrowing availability of $45
million on December 31, 2003, the Company could operate successfully without the
$99 million in cash, given that the Company was operating with a positive EBITDA
on a quarterly basis. Therefore, we believe we have adequate liquidity to
operate the business successfully for the next 12 months and to invest in growth
opportunities. As of December 31, 2003, our gross-debt-to-total capitalization
ratio was 10%. We do not have significant debt obligations that are due prior to
December 24, 2005; therefore, we believe that we have adequate liquidity to
operate through this period. On December 24, 2005, our credit facility with GE
Commercial Finance in Australia expires. As of December 31, 2003, we had $11.9
million outstanding


A-69


on the facility. Our relationship with GE Commercial Finance is good; therefore,
we expect to be in a position to either extend this facility or to find an
alternative lender.

Our cash balance at December 31, 2003, was distributed throughout our
subsidiaries worldwide. However, we had higher concentrations of cash in the
U.S. and in Asia Pacific and both pools were denominated in U.S. dollars.
Although we can generally move funds freely across our subsidiaries, if we were
to repatriate funds to the U.S. from foreign subsidiaries we could incur tax
consequences, which may cause us to pay higher taxes and consume additional cash
as a consequence. In certain subsidiaries, our local lenders restrict the amount
of funds that can be transferred offshore to affiliates and the parent company.
Additionally, there are foreign capital restrictions in India, which would
restrict our ability to repatriate cash from India.

We currently fund a portion of our discontinued operations with cash generated
from our continuing operations. Our total net liabilities for discontinued
operations were $2.3 million as of December 31, 2003, and we expect to consume
cash in the future to pay these liabilities. Local tax authorities generally
review or audit tax returns for discontinued operations. Assessments beyond
liabilities that are known and accrued for may result from any tax audit and
such assessment could consume additional cash.

CREDIT RATING

We are rated by Standard & Poor's. As of December 31, 2003, our rating was B+
with a "stable" outlook. Standard & Poor's upgraded their rating for the Company
on August 28, 2003 from B with a "stable" outlook.

SEASONALITY

The Company is subject to seasonal patterns that generally affect the wireless
device industry. The wireless device is generally used by businesses,
governments and consumers. For businesses and governments, purchasing behavior
is affected by fiscal year ends, while consumers are affected by holiday
gift-giving seasons. For the global wireless device industry, seasonal patterns
for wireless device units handled have been as follows:



Quarter 2003 2002 2001
- ------- ---- ---- ----

1st 21.2% 22.8% 23.3%
2nd 22.3% 23.5% 23.9%
3rd 25.7% 25.3% 24.5%
4th 30.8% 28.4% 28.3%


For the Company, seasonal patterns for wireless devices handled have been as
follows:



Quarter 2003 2002 2001
- ------- ---- ---- ----

1st 19.4% 23.4% 27.8%
2nd 20.4% 24.2% 21.6%
3rd 29.6% 24.7% 25.1%
4th 30.6% 27.7% 25.5%


As can be seen in the table above, the wireless device industry has been prone
to experiencing increases in demand in the fourth quarter, primarily due to
enterprise purchasing for companies whose fiscal year ends


A-70


coincide with the calendar year end and gift-giving holidays. Network operators
often increase promotional activity, which can further stimulate demand during
this period. Conversely, the global wireless industry has experienced decreases
in demand in the first quarter subsequent to the higher level of activity in the
preceding fourth quarter.

The Company's seasonal patterns are significantly influenced by the global
wireless industry's seasonal patterns. Our high growth in our Asia Pacific
Division in 2002 and 2003, which included our entry into India in the second
quarter of 2003, has partially caused our seasonal patterns to differ from the
global wireless industry. The Chinese New Year, which is in the first quarter of
each year, historically has had a positive influence in demand in the first
quarter. This has affected demand in certain markets in our Asia Pacific
division. The gift-giving holiday in India generally occurs in October. We
encountered high demand in the third quarter of 2003 partially as a result of
this seasonal event. In certain markets in the Asia Pacific division, enterprise
and government fiscal years commonly end on June 30, which historically has had
a positive effect on demand in the second quarter of 2002. As compared to the
global wireless industry, our seasonality will likely be affected by the
quantity of wireless devices handled in markets whose seasonality differs from
the global wireless industry. Additionally, should we enter into new markets
throughout the year, the additional wireless devices handled in those new
markets may affect the distribution of sales across the four quarters of the
year as compared to the global wireless and our own historical seasonal
patterns. There can be no assurances that our future seasonal patterns will
resemble that of the global wireless industry or that of our own historical
patterns. Additionally, interim results may not be indicative of annual results.

CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS AND COMMITMENTS

Our disclosures regarding cash requirements of contractual obligations and
commercial commitments are located in various parts of our regulatory filings.
Information in the following table provides a summary of our contractual
obligations and commercial commitments as of December 31, 2003.



(Amounts in 000s) Payments due by Period
-------------------------------------------------------------
Total 2004 2005 2006 Thereafter
-------- -------- -------- -------- ----------

Third-party debt and lines of credit (1) $ 16,207 $ -- $ 16,207 $ -- $ --
Operating leases 79,703 9,340 6,830 6,309 57,225
Purchase obligations (2) 14,331 14,331 -- -- --
Letters of credit 28,334 28,334 -- -- --
Other (3) 2,637 1,476 876 285 --
-------- -------- -------- -------- --------
Total $141,212 $ 53,481 $ 23,913 $ 6,594 $ 57,225
======== ======== ======== ======== ========


(1) reflects amounts included on the Consolidated Balance Sheet

(2) purchase obligations exclude agreements that are cancelable without
penalty

(3) includes obligations under maintenance contracts, acquisition
agreements, and other commercial commitments


A-71


RESULTS OF OPERATIONS - 2002 COMPARISON TO 2001

Revenue by Division:



(Amounts in 000s) YEAR ENDED
--------------------------------------------------------------- Change from
December 31, % of December 31, % of 2001 to
2002 Total 2001 Total 2002
------------ ---------- ------------ ---------- -----------

Asia-Pacific $ 527,499 41% $ 339,749 27% 55%
Americas 493,203 39% 650,581 51% (24%)
Europe 255,365 20% 273,370 22% (7%)
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
Total $1,276,067 100% $1,263,700 100% 1%
========== ========== ========== ========== ==========


Revenue by Service Line:



(Amounts in 000s) YEAR ENDED
-------------------------------------------------------------- Change from
December 31, % of December 31, % of 2001 to
2002 Total 2001 Total 2002
------------ ---------- ------------ ---------- -----------

Product distribution $1,089,534 85% $1,107,802 88% (2%)
Integrated logistics services 186,533 15% 155,898 12% 20%
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
Total $1,276,067 100% $1,263,700 100% 1%
========== ========== ========== ========== ==========


Revenue increased 1% in 2002 when compared to 2001, which was primarily
attributable to increases in handset demand in certain developing Asia-Pacific
markets, in which we experienced higher growth rates due to increases in
subscriber growth. These increases in 2002 were partially offset by declines in
product distribution in our Americas and Europe divisions, in which we
experienced during 2002 a sales mix shift from product distribution to
integrated logistics services and a general reduction in product subsidies and
the number of promotional programs sponsored by wireless network operators.

Revenue in the Asia-Pacific division increased in 2002 when compared to 2001
across all markets, but was most significant in the Brightpoint Asia Limited
operation, which experienced higher growth rates due to increases in subscriber
growth in certain developing Asia markets. Our Brightpoint Asia Limited
operation, which represented approximately 27% of our total revenue in 2002,
sells Nokia products to a limited number of resellers based in Hong Kong and
Singapore, predominantly on a cash-before-delivery basis.

Revenue in the Americas division declined 24% in 2002 when compared to 2001. The
decrease was due primarily to; i) a service line mix shift in 2002 from
distribution services which had average selling prices of approximately $137 per
unit handled to logistics services which have average selling prices of under
$20 per unit, ii) pricing pressures related to our integrated logistics
services, iii) lower average selling prices in 2002 for wireless devices in the
United States, and iv) declines in accessory program demand during 2002. The
shift in service line mix resulted from, among other factors, the loss of
certain distribution customers due to industry consolidation, lack of
availability of certain CDMA-based wireless devices in our product offering, the
shift of certain customers from distribution services to integrated logistics
services, acquisition of new integrated logistics services customers and
expansion of our logistics services product offerings partially offset by the
loss of certain logistics services contracts. The decline in wireless devices'
average selling prices in the United States was primarily attributable to
product availability from our suppliers and demand for lower-priced models. The
decline in accessory program demand was primarily due to reduced network
operator promotions, technological advancement in


A-72


wireless devices, and bundling of accessories with wireless devices by certain
suppliers and wireless network operators.

Revenue in the Europe division decreased by 7% in 2002 when compared to 2001.
The decrease in revenue during 2002 was primarily the result of decreased demand
in Ireland and France resulting from fewer network operator promotions and
subsidies, as well as, the expiration in the fourth quarter of 2002 of our
exclusive agreement with a network operator in Ireland to provide distribution
and logistics services. These declines were partially offset by increased
revenues for our Sweden operation (including its Norway branch which initiated
operations in the second quarter of 2002), which experienced increased demand
for its services supporting prepaid programs during 2002.

GROSS PROFIT AND GROSS MARGIN

Gross Profit by Service Line:



YEAR ENDED
---------------------------------------------------------------- Change from
(Amounts in 000s) December 31, % of December 31, % of 2001 to
2002 Total 2001 Total 2002
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------

Product distribution $ 29,316 41% $ 39,922 54% (27%)
Integrated logistics services 42,678 59% 33,853 46% 26%
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Total $ 71,994 100% $ 73,775 100% (2%)
============ ============ ============ ============ ============


Gross Margin by Service Line:



YEAR ENDED
------------------------------------ Change from
December 31, December 31, 2001 to
2002 2001 2002
------------ ------------ --------------

Product distribution 2.7% 3.6% 0.9% points
Integrated logistics services 22.9% 21.7% (1.2)% points
---- ---- ----
Total 5.6% 5.8% (0.2)% points
==== ==== ====


Gross profit in 2002 decreased 2% from 2001 and gross margin decreased by 20
basis points to 5.6% in 2002 as compared to 5.8% in 2001. Gross profit was
negatively impacted in both 2002 and 2001 by certain significant items
including; i) inventory valuation adjustments during 2002 of approximately $3.6
million to adjust inventories to their net realizable value based on the then
current market conditions, ii) the recognition of a loss in the second quarter
of 2002 of approximately $2.5 million, related to a purchase obligation to an
accessory vendor and iii) inventory valuation adjustments of approximately $13.7
million in the second quarter of 2001.

In addition to these items, gross profit was also negatively impacted in 2002
when compared to 2001 by; i) the shift in our revenue to a greater proportion of
wireless device sales which generally have a lower gross margin than accessories
or integrated logistic services, ii) pricing concessions for certain integrated
logistic services customers in our Americas division and iii) reduced margins in
the Asia-Pacific region due to changes in vendor incentive and rebate programs
and increased cost for outsourced warehouse management services related to our
Brightpoint Asia Limited operations. The first additional factor (i) indicates
that gross profit was negatively impacted by the shift in our revenue to a
greater proportion of wireless device sales, which generally have a lower gross
margin than accessories or integrated logistics services. In 2002, wireless
handset sales were 85% of our total revenue as compared to 88% in 2001. Our
average gross margin percentage, excluding inventory write-downs, in 2002 and
2001 on wireless handset sales was approximately 4.6% compared to a combined
average gross margin percentage on wireless


A-73


accessory and logistics of over 10% each year. The second additional factor (ii)
indicates that pricing concessions for certain integrated logistics services
customers in our Americas division negatively impacted gross profit. Average
integrated logistics services fees per unit in the Company's Americas division
declined over 40% in 2002 compared to 2001 while wireless devices handled for
integrated logistics service customers increased in 2002 when compared to 2001.
The third additional factor (iii) indicates that gross profit was negatively
impacted by reduced margins in the Asia-Pacific Region due to changes in vendor
incentive and rebate programs and increased costs of outsourced warehouse
management services related to our Brightpoint Asia Limited operations. Gross
margin percentage in our Asia-Pacific region declined to 4.4% in 2002 as
compared to 6.3% in 2001. In 2002, incentive rebates from a primary supplier for
our Brightpoint Asia Limited operations decreased from approximately 4.5% of
this operation's gross revenue in 2001 to 3.5% of its gross revenue in 2002.
Additionally, we incurred approximately $1.4 million in warehouse management
service fees pursuant to the outsourcing of these services to Chinatron. These
services were performed internally by our former Hong Kong operations in 2001.

SELLING, GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE ("SG&A") EXPENSES



YEAR ENDED
------------------------------------ Change from
(Amounts in 000s) December 31, December 31, 2001 to
2002 2001 2002
------------ ------------ ------------

SG&A expenses $71,247 $66,396 7%
Percentage of revenue 5.6% 5.3% 0.3% points


Selling, general and administrative expenses increased 7% in 2002 compared to
2001. The increase was the result of one-time costs related to cost reduction
action taken in 2002, increased legal costs, increased bad debt expenses and
severance costs related to management changes. The increase in legal costs was
primarily the result of certain class action litigation and an inquiry from the
SEC.

OPERATING INCOME

Operating Income by Division:



YEAR ENDED
---------------------------------------------------------------- Change from
(Amounts in 000s) December 31, % of December 31, % of 2001 to
2002 Total 2001 Total 2002
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------

Asia-Pacific $ 6,465 N/M $ 9,285 N/M (30%)
The Americas (2,030) N/M (6,481) N/M N/M
Europe (3,688) N/M 3,970 N/M N/M
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Total $ 747 100% $ 6,774 100% (88%)
============ ============ ============ ============ ============

N/M: Not Meaningful

Operating Income as a Percent of Revenue by Division:



YEAR ENDED
------------------------------------- Change from
December 31, December 31, 2001 to
2002 2001 2002
------------ ------------ -------------

Asia-Pacific 1.2% 2.7% (1.5)% points
The Americas (0.4%) (1.0%) 0.6% points
Europe (1.4%) 1.5% (2.9)% points
---- ---- ----
Total 0.1% 0.5% (0.4)% points
==== ==== ====



A-74


The decrease in operating income is primarily the result of the decrease in
gross margin and the increase in selling, general and administrative expenses as
a percent of revenue. Gross profit was negatively impacted in both 2002 and 2001
by certain significant items including inventory valuation adjustments, the
shift in our revenue to a greater proportion of wireless device sales which
generally have a lower gross margin than accessories or integrated logistic
services, pricing concessions for certain integrated logistic services customers
in our Americas division and reduced margins in the Asia-Pacific region due to
changes in vendor incentive and rebate programs and increased cost for
outsourced warehouse management services related to our Brightpoint Asia Limited
operations. The increase in selling, general and administrative expenses was the
result of one-time costs related to cost reduction action taken in 2002,
increased legal costs, increased bad debt expenses and severance costs related
to management changes.

IMPAIRMENT LOSS ON LONG-TERM INVESTMENT

During the second half of 2001, we experienced lower than desired operating
results and returns on invested capital in our Brightpoint China Limited
operation primarily due to: i) continuing migration of Brightpoint China's
business from Hong Kong to mainland China ii) continuing reliance on a single
supplier for products within China with no exclusive product lines and iii) the
level of invested capital required to conduct this business was substantial
considering the risk of operating in China. A number of alternatives were
considered with respect to decreasing our financial and economic exposure to the
China market and as a result, in January 2002, we formed a joint venture with
Chinatron through their purchase of a 50% interest in Brightpoint China Limited,
which was at the time our wholly-owned subsidiary. In this transaction, we
granted Chinatron the option to purchase an additional 30% interest in this
subsidiary we received 6,414,607 Chinatron Class B Preference Shares with a face
value of $10 million convertible into 10% of the issued and outstanding ordinary
shares of Chinatron in consideration. At the formation of the joint venture,
Brightpoint China Limited had a net book value of $18.8 million. In March of
2002, rather than exercising its option, Chinatron offered to purchase our
remaining interest in Brightpoint China Limited for 7,928,166 Chinatron Class B
Preference Shares with a face value of $11 million that were convertible into
11% of the issued and outstanding ordinary shares in Chinatron. This transaction
closed in April 2002, bringing our aggregate holdings in Chinatron to 14,342,773
Class B Preference Shares with an aggregate face value of $21 million that were
convertible into 19.9% of the issued and outstanding ordinary shares of
Chinatron. The net book value of Brightpoint China Limited at the time of the
sale of remaining 50% interest in Brightpoint China Limited was $5.2 million. At
the time of the formation of the joint venture, the Company was not aware that
the actual value of the Chinatron Class B Preference Shares was significantly
below the face value because the Company had not yet completed a valuation of
the shares.

When the Company's internal valuations and analyses were completed, we estimated
a fair market value of $10.3 million for our aggregate holdings of 14,342,773
Chinatron Class B Preference Shares with a face value of $21 million. As of June
30, 2002, we believed the Chinatron Class B Preference Shares continued to have
an estimated fair market value of approximately $10.3 million.

During the third quarter of 2002, Chinatron sought to raise additional capital
to fund its operations and meet its business objectives. In September and
October of 2002, because of our own liquidity constraints and to help Chinatron
secure funding from other parties, which we believed would improve Chinatron's
ability to honor its remaining debt obligations of the Chinatron Class B
Preference Shares owned by us, we waived our right to participate in these
capital-raising activities, waived our right to require Chinatron


A-75


to redeem a portion of the Class B Preference Shares and agreed to modify the
conversion ratio of the preference shares. Collectively, these actions reduced
our ownership interest in Chinatron from 19.9% to less than 1%. However, all
other rights of the Chinatron Class B Preference Shares, including our right to
require Chinatron to redeem all or a portion of the Chinatron Class B Preference
Shares under certain circumstances, remained.

As discussed in greater detail in Note 4 to the Consolidated Financial
Statements, we recorded a non-cash impairment charge during the third quarter of
2002 of $8.3 million relating to our investment in the Chinatron Class B
Preference Shares. Management is responsible for estimating the value of the
Chinatron Class B Preference Shares. In accordance with SFAS 115, Accounting for
Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities, the Company designated the
Chinatron Class B Preference Shares as held-to-maturity. The carrying value was
approximately $2 million at December 31, 2003 and 2002. See Notes 4 and 7 to the
Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion of the divestiture of
Brightpoint China Limited and our Chinatron investment.

GAIN ON DEBT EXTINGUISHMENT

During 2002, we repurchased 228,068 of our 250,000 of our then outstanding
Convertible Notes. The repurchases were made under a plan approved by our Board
of Directors on November 1, 2001, which allowed us to repurchase the remaining
outstanding Convertible Notes. The aggregate purchase price for the Convertible
Notes was approximately $75 million (at an average cost of $329 per Convertible
Note) and was funded by a combination of working capital and a borrowing of $15
million under the credit facility with General Electric Commercial Finance and
our primary North American operating subsidiaries, Brightpoint North America
L.P. and Wireless Fulfillment Services, LLC. Approximately $30 million of the
working capital funding came from Brightpoint Holdings B.V., our primary foreign
finance subsidiary. As of December 31, 2002, the remaining 21,932 Convertible
Notes had an accreted book value of approximately $12.0 million, or $548 per
Convertible Note. These transactions resulted in a gain of approximately $44
million. The tax effect of the Convertible Note repurchases was largely offset
by net operating losses resulting in no significant cash tax payments.

During 2001, we repurchased 36,000 of our then outstanding Convertible Notes for
approximately $10 million (an average cost of $281 per Convertible Note). These
transactions resulted in a gain of approximately $7.2 million.

INCOME FROM CONTINUING OPERATIONS



(Amounts in 000s) YEAR ENDED
------------------------------------ Change from
December 31, December 31, 2001 to
2002 2001 2002
------------ ------------ ----------

Income (loss) from continuing
operations $ 13,805 $ 3,098 346%
Per share - basic and diluted $ 0.77 $ 0.17 353%


The increase in income from continuing operations in 2002 as compared to 2001
was primarily a result of the gain on extinguishment of debt in 2002 of $44
million, which was partially offset by the impairment loss on long-term
investment of $8.3 million, increased income tax expense of $12.6 million and
increased selling, general and administrative expenses of $4.9 million. The
increase in selling, general and


A-76


administrative expenses is primarily a result of one-time costs related to cost
reduction action taken in 2002, increased legal costs, increased bad debt
expenses and severance costs related to management changes.

DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS

In connection with the adoption of SFAS No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment
or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets, the results of operations and related disposal
costs, gains and losses for business units that we have eliminated or sold are
classified in discontinued operations, for all periods presented.

During the fourth quarter of 2002, we and certain of our subsidiaries sold
certain operating assets of Brightpoint de Mexico, S.A. de C.V. and their
respective ownership interests in Servicios Brightpoint de Mexico, S.A. de C.V.
to Soluciones Inteligentes para el Mercado Movil, S.A. de C.V., an entity which
is wholly-owned and controlled by Brightstar de Mexico S.A. de C.V. Pursuant to
the transaction, we received cash consideration totaling approximately $1.7
million and a short-term promissory note from Soluciones Inteligentes para el
Mercado Movil, S.A. de C.V. totaling approximately $1.1 million that matured in
December 2002. The repayment of the promissory note was guaranteed by Brightstar
de Mexico S.A. de C.V. We recorded a net loss on the transaction of $2.2 million
in 2002, which included a $3.5 million non-cash write-off of cumulative foreign
currency translation adjustments and $3.4 million in tax benefits to be realized
pursuant to the transaction. In addition, during the fourth quarter, we
committed to a plan to sell our Puerto Rico operations which sale was completed
in February of 2003. Consequently, the financial results of Puerto Rico are
presented in the Consolidated Statement of Operations as "Discontinued
Operations."

During the third quarter of 2002, we and certain of our subsidiaries sold their
respective ownership interests in Brightpoint Middle East FZE, and its
subsidiary Fono Distribution Services LLC, and Brightpoint Jordan Limited to
Persequor Limited, an entity controlled by the former Managing Director of our
operations in the Middle East and certain members of his management team.
Pursuant to the transaction, we received two subordinated promissory notes with
face values of $1.2 million and $3.0 million that mature in 2004 and 2006,
respectively. The notes bear interest at 4% per annum and were recorded at a
discount to face value for an aggregate carrying amount at December 31, 2002 of
$3.4 million. In addition, under the Sale and Purchase Agreement, we may receive
additional proceeds, which are contingent upon collection of accounts receivable
from a certain customer. We received $300 thousand in contingent consideration
during the fourth quarter of 2002 related to the transaction. There can be no
assurance we will receive any additional proceeds. We recorded an initial loss
on the transaction of $1.6 million, including the recognition of accumulated
foreign currency translation gains of $300 thousand. Concurrent with the
completion of this transaction, $5 million of cash, which was pledged by
Brightpoint Holdings B.V. to support letters of credit utilized by our
operations in the Middle East, was released and was classified as unrestricted.
We have paid and will pay management fees, including performance based bonuses,
to Persequor for providing management services relating to the sales activities
of Brightpoint Asia Limited which we retained pursuant to the transaction.

During 2002, we continued the execution of our 2001 restructuring plan, which
called for the elimination of operations in Brazil, Jamaica, South Africa,
Venezuela and Zimbabwe and the consolidation of our operations and activities in
Germany, the Netherlands and Belgium, including regional management, into a new
facility in Germany. Additionally, during the first and second quarters of 2002,
we completed,


A-77


through certain of our subsidiaries, the divestiture of our interests in
Brightpoint China Limited to Hong Kong based Chinatron. Pursuant to the
transaction with Chinatron, we received preference shares in Chinatron with an
aggregate face value of $21 million. We currently estimate that our total
investment in Chinatron preference shares has a fair market value of
approximately $2 million. See Notes 4 and 7 to the Consolidated Financial
Statements for further discussion of the 2001 restructuring plan, the
divestiture of Brightpoint China Limited and our Chinatron investment.

In 2002, aggregate losses in discontinued operations were approximately $15.5
million ($0.86 per diluted share) compared to $56 million ($3.14 per diluted
share) in 2001. The aggregate loss in discontinued operations during 2002 was
comprised primarily of the losses on disposal of our former Mexico and Middle
East operations discussed above. The aggregate loss in discontinued operations
in 2001 includes $46 million ($34 million, net of tax benefits) in costs and
non-cash charges related to the execution of the 2001 restructuring plan, a $3.4
million ($2.8 million, net of tax benefits) one-time charge resulting from the
settlement of disputed amount due to us from a handset manufacturer and with
which we severed our relationship and $19.3 million in net operating losses from
discontinued entities.

For 2002 and 2001, discontinued operations experienced net losses of $12.9
million and $22 million, respectively, on revenue of $120 million and $561
million, respectively. In addition, these operations also experienced net losses
on disposal of discontinued operations of approximately $2.6 million and $34.3
million in 2002 and 2001, respectively.

CUMULATIVE EFFECT OF A CHANGE IN ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLE

As of January 1, 2002, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting
Standards No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets ("SFAS No. 142").
Pursuant to the provisions of SFAS 142 the Company stopped amortizing goodwill
as of January 1, 2002 and performs an impairment test on its goodwill at least
annually. During the second quarter of 2002, the Company completed the
transitional impairment test required under SFAS No. 142. During the first
quarter of 2002, as a result of the initial transitional impairment test, the
Company recorded an impairment charge of approximately $41 million, which is
presented as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of
tax, for the three and nine months ended September 30, 2002. On October 1, 2002
and 2003, the Company performed the required annual impairment test on its
remaining goodwill and incurred no significant additional impairment charges.

NET INCOME (LOSS)



(Amounts in 000s) YEAR ENDED
------------------------------------ Change from
December 31, December 31, 2001 to
2002 2001 2002
------------ ------------ -------------

Net loss $ (42,421) $ (53,301) 20%
As a percent of revenue (3.3%) (4.2%) 0.9% points

Per share - basic and diluted $ (2.35) $ (2.97) 21%


During 2002, the net loss decreased 20% compared to 2001, primarily as a result
of the gain on extinguishment of debt of $44 million and the decrease in losses
in discontinued operations of $41 million, partially offset by increased income
tax expense of $12.6 million, the impairment loss on long-term investment of
$8.3 million, and increased selling, general and administrative expenses of $4.9
million.


A-78


The increase in income tax expense was directly related to increased taxable
income primarily from the gain on extinguishment of debt. The increase in
selling, general and administrative expenses is primarily a result of one-time
costs related to cost reduction action taken in 2002, increased legal costs,
increased bad debt expenses and severance costs related to management changes.

RECENTLY ISSUED ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

In 2003, Emerging Issues Task Force ("EITF") reached a consensus on the issue
No. 00-21 ("EITF 00-21"), Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliveries. EITF
00-21 addresses certain aspects of the accounting by a vendor for arrangements
under which it will perform multiple revenue-generating activities.
Specifically, this EITF 00-21 addresses how to determine whether an arrangement
involving multiple deliverables contains more than one unit of accounting. In
applying this EITF 00-21, separate contracts with the same entity or related
parties that are entered into at or near the same time are presumed to have been
negotiated as a package and should, therefore, be evaluated as a single
arrangement in considering whether there are one or more units of accounting.
EITF 00-21 is effective for revenue arrangements entered into in periods
(including quarterly periods) beginning after June 15, 2003. The Company adopted
this standard on a prospective basis. The adoption of EITF 00-21 related to new
agreements did not have an impact on the financial position or results of
operations of the Company.

Also in 2003, Emerging Issues Task Force reached a consensus on the issue No.
02-16 ("EITF 02-16"), Accounting by a Customer (Including a Reseller) for
Certain Consideration Received from a Vendor and No. 03-10("EITF 03-10"),
Application of Issue No. 02-16 by Resellers to Sales Incentives Offered to
Consumers by Manufacturers which address accounting for vendor programs. EITF
02-16 addressed accounting for cash consideration received by a reseller from a
vendor. Cash consideration received by a customer from a vendor is presumed to
be a reduction of the prices of the vendor's products or services and should be
characterized as a reduction of cost of sales when recognized in the customer's
income statement. However, if the consideration is a payment for assets or
services delivered to the vendor, the cash consideration is characterized as
revenue when recognized in the customer's income statement. The EITF also
addressed rebates or refunds and how they should be recognized as a reduction of
cost of sales. In order to recognize a rebate or refund, it must be probable and
reasonably estimable, otherwise, it is not recognized until each specified
criteria is met. EITF 03-10 addressed sales incentives that are offered to the
consumer by manufacturers that are honored by resellers. The consensus was that
these types of incentive should not be reported as a reduction of the costs of
the reseller's purchases from the vendor. If the consideration does not meet the
four specific criteria outlined in EITF 03-10, then the consideration received
is subject to the guidance in EITF 02-16. The Company has not changed its
presentation or accounting for vendor programs as a result of EITF 02-16 or EITF
03-10. We believe that our current practices comply with both EITFs.

In December 2003, the Securities and Exchange Commission issued Staff Accounting
Bulletin ("SAB") No. 104 ("SAB 104"), Revenue Recognition. This SAB updates
portions of the SEC staff's interpretive guidance provided in SAB 101 and
included in Topic 13 of the Codification of Staff Accounting Bulletins. SAB 104
deletes interpretative material no longer necessary, and conforms the
interpretive material retained, because of pronouncements issued by the
Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") Emerging Issues Task Force on
various revenue recognition topics, including EITF 00-21. The Company adopted
this standard on a prospective basis. The adoption of SAB 104 did not have an
impact on the financial position or results of operations of the Company.


A-79


In 2003, the FASB issued Interpretation No. 46 ("FIN 46"), Consolidation of
Variable Interest Entities. FIN 46 defines a variable interest entity ("VIE")
as a corporation, partnership, trust or any other legal structure that does not
have equity investors with a controlling financial interest or has equity
investors that do not provide sufficient financial resources for the entity to
support its activities. FIN 46 requires consolidation of a VIE by the primary
beneficiary of the assets, liabilities, and results of activities effective for
2003. FIN 46 also requires certain disclosures by all holders of a significant
variable interest in a VIE that are not the primary beneficiary. The Company
does not have any VIE's. The adoption of FIN No. 46 did not have a material
impact on the financial position or results of operations of the Company.

In May 2003, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 150
("SFAS No. 150"), Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments with
Characteristics of both Liabilities and Equity. SFAS No. 150 establishes
standards for how an issuer classifies and measures certain financial
instruments with characteristics of both liabilities and equity. It requires
that an issuer classify certain financial instruments as a liability (or as an
asset in some circumstances). SFAS No. 150 was effective for the Company at the
beginning of the first interim period beginning after June 15, 2003. The
adoption of SFAS No. 150 did not have a material impact on the financial
position or results of operations of the Company.

In April 2003, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No.
149 ("SFAS No. 149"), Amendment of Statement 133 on Derivative Instruments and
Hedging Activities. SFAS No. 149 amends and clarifies accounting for derivative
instruments, including certain derivative instruments embedded in other
contracts, and for hedging activities under Statement 133 and is to be applied
prospectively to contracts entered into or modified after June 30, 2003. The
adoption of SFAS No. 149 did not have a material impact on the financial
position or results of operations of the Company.


A-80


OPERATING SEGMENTS AND GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION

The Company's operations are divided into three geographic operating segments.
These operating segments represent its three divisions: The Americas,
Asia-Pacific and Europe. These divisions all derive revenues from sales of
wireless devices, accessory programs and fees from the provision of integrated
logistics services.

The Company evaluates the performance of, and allocates resources to, these
segments based on operating income from continuing operations including
allocated corporate selling, general and administrative expenses. As discussed
in Note 7 to the Consolidated Financial Statements, the Company discontinued
several operating entities, which materially affected certain operating
segments. All years presented below have been reclassified to reflect the
reclassification of discontinued operating entities to discontinued operations.
A summary of the Company's operations by segment is presented below (in
thousands) for 2003, 2002 and 2001:



Product
Distribution Integrated Logistics Total Operating Allocated
Revenue from Services Revenue Revenue Income from Total Allocated Income
External from External from External Continuing Segment Interest Tax Expense
Customers Customers Customers Operations Assets Expense (1) (Benefit) (1)
------------ -------------------- ------------- ----------- ---------- ----------- -------------

2003:
ASIA-PACIFIC $ 962,682 $ 33,116 $ 995,798 $ 14,088 $ 159,005 $ 217 $ 3,117
THE AMERICAS 394,044 75,574 469,618 3,621 190,077 594 610
EUROPE 216,774 118,184 334,958 3,186 95,608 335 238
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
$1,573,500 $ 226,874 $1,800,374 $ 20,895 $ 444,690 $ 1,146 $ 3,965
========== ========== ========== ========== ========== ========== ==========

2002:
Asia-Pacific $ 504,866 $ 22,613 $ 527,499 $ 6,465 $ 84,920 $ 1,717 $ 476
The Americas 418,147 75,056 493,203 (2,030) 173,371 3,109 15,906
Europe 166,501 88,864 255,365 (3,688) 78,011 1,073 (1,202)
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
$1,089,534 $ 186,533 $1,276,067 $ 747 $ 336,302 $ 5,899 $ 15,180
========== ========== ========== ========== ========== ========== ==========

2001:
Asia-Pacific $ 324,031 $ 15,718 $ 339,749 $ 9,285 $ 98,539 $ 2,187 $ 1,541
The Americas 592,762 57,819 650,581 (6,481) 402,030 4,726 489
Europe 191,009 82,361 273,370 3,970 108,851 1,257 512
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
$1,107,802 $ 155,898 $1,263,700 $ 6,774 $ 609,420 $ 8,170 $ 2,542
========== ========== ========== ========== ========== ========== ==========


(1) These items are allocated using various methods and are not necessarily
indicative of the actual interest expense and income taxes for the
applicable divisions.

Additional segment information is as follows (in thousands):



DECEMBER 31
----------------------------------
2003 2002 2001
-------- -------- --------

Long-lived assets:
Asia-Pacific $ 9,636 $ 7,479 $ 28,121
The Americas 27,121 38,274 60,841
Europe 21,482 16,947 32,683
-------- -------- --------
$ 58,239 $ 62,700 $121,645
======== ======== ========



A-81


FUTURE OPERATING RESULTS

Various statements, discussions and analyses throughout this Annual Report on
Form 10-K are not based on historical fact and contain forward-looking
statements. Actual future results may differ materially from the forward-looking
statements in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Future trends for revenue and
profitability are difficult to predict due to a variety of known and unknown
risks and uncertainties, including, without limitation, (i) dependence upon
principal suppliers and availability and price of wireless products; (ii) loss
of significant customers or a reduction in prices we charge these customers;
(iii) reliance on third party to manage significant operations in our
Asia-Pacific division; (iv) lack of demand for our products and services in
certain markets and our inability to maintain margins; (v) our ability to
absorb, through revenue growth, the increasing operating costs that we have
incurred and continue to incur in connection with our activities; (vi)
uncertainty whether wireless equipment manufacturers and network operators will
continue to outsource aspects of their business to us; (vii) possible adverse
effect on demand for our products resulting from consolidation of wireless
network operator customers; (viii) economic conditions in our markets; (ix)
ability to respond to rapid technological changes in the wireless communications
and data industry; (x) possible difficulties collecting our accounts receivable;
(xi) access to or the cost of increasing amounts of capital, trade credit or
other financing; (xii) risks of foreign operations, including currency, trade
restrictions and political risks in our foreign markets; (xiii) effect of
hostilities or terrorist attacks on our operations; (xiv) reliance on
sophisticated information systems technologies; (xv) ability to meet intense
industry competition; (xvi) ability to manage and sustain future growth at our
historical or industry rates; (xvii) success of relationships with wireless
equipment manufacturers, network operators and other participants in the global
wireless industry; (xviii) our recent history of losses; (xix) seasonality; (xx)
ability to attract and retain qualified management and other personnel; (xxi)
cost of complying with labor agreements; (xxii) ability to protect our
proprietary information; (xxiii) high rate of personnel turnover; (xxiv) our
significant payment obligations under certain lease and other contractual
arrangements; (xxv) possible adverse effects of future medical claims regarding
the use of wireless handsets; (xxvi) uncertainties regarding the outcome of
pending litigation; (xxvii) ability to maintain adequate business insurance at
reasonable cost and (xxviii) existence of anti-takeover measures. Because of the
aforementioned uncertainties affecting our future operating results, past
performance should not be considered to be a reliable indicator of future
performance, and investors should not use historical trends to anticipate future
results or trends.


A-82


FINANCIAL MARKET RISK MANAGEMENT

INTEREST RATE AND FOREIGN CURRENCY EXCHANGE RATE RISKS

We are exposed to financial market risks, including changes in interest rates
and foreign currency exchange rates. To mitigate interest rate risks, we have
historically utilized interest rate swaps to convert certain portions of our
variable rate debt to fixed interest rates. To mitigate foreign currency
exchange rate risks, we periodically utilize derivative financial instruments
under the Foreign Currency Risk Management Policy approved by our Board of
Directors. We do not use derivative instruments for speculative or trading
purposes.

We are exposed to changes in interest rates on our variable interest rate
revolving lines of credit. A 10% increase in short-term borrowing rates during
2003 would have resulted in only a nominal increase in interest expense. We did
not have any interest rate swaps outstanding at December 31, 2003.

A substantial portion of our revenue and expenses are transacted in markets
worldwide and may be denominated in currencies other than the U.S. dollar.
Accordingly, our future results could be adversely affected by a variety of
factors, including changes in specific countries' political, economic or
regulatory conditions and trade protection measures.

Our foreign currency risk management program is designed to reduce, but not
eliminate, unanticipated fluctuations in earnings and cash flows caused by
volatility in currency exchange rates by hedging. Generally, through purchase of
forward contracts, we hedge transactional currency risk, but do not hedge
foreign currency revenue or operating income. Also, we do not hedge our
investment in foreign subsidiaries, where fluctuations in foreign currency
exchange rates may affect our comprehensive income or loss. An adverse change
(defined as a 10% strengthening of the U.S. dollar) in all exchange rates would
have had no material impact on our results of operations for 2003. At December
31, 2003, there were no cash flow or net investment hedges open. Our sensitivity
analysis of foreign currency exchange rate movements does not factor in a
potential change in volumes or local currency prices of our products sold or
services provided. Actual results may differ materially from those discussed
above.


A-83


OTHER INFORMATION

COMMON STOCK INFORMATION (UNAUDITED)

Our Common Stock is listed on the NASDAQ Stock Market(R) under the symbol CELL.
The following tables set forth, for the periods indicated, the high and low sale
prices for the Common Stock as reported by the NASDAQ Stock Market(R).



2003 HIGH LOW
- ---- ------- --------

FIRST QUARTER $ 7.71 $ 3.54
SECOND QUARTER 7.42 4.94
THIRD QUARTER 24.85 5.37
FOURTH QUARTER 28.65 15.90




2002 High Low
- ---- ------- --------

First quarter $ 11.63 $ 2.05
Second quarter 3.05 0.56
Third quarter 1.22 0.53
Fourth quarter 3.98 0.71


At March 1, 2004, there were approximately 309 stockholders of record.

We have not paid cash dividends on our Common Stock other than S corporation
distributions made to stockholders during periods prior to the rescissions of S
corporation elections by our predecessors or us. In addition, our bank
agreements limit or prohibit us, subject to certain exceptions, from declaring
or paying cash dividends, making capital distributions or other payments to
stockholders. The Board of Directors intends to continue a policy of retaining
earnings to finance the growth and development of our business and does not
expect to declare or pay any cash dividends in the foreseeable future.

We have declared the following forward and reverse common stock splits, all of
the forward stock splits, which were affected in the form of common stock
dividends:



DIVIDEND PAYMENT OR
DECLARATION DATE STOCK SPLIT EFFECTIVE DATE SPLIT RATIO
---------------- -------------------------- -----------

August 31, 1995 September 20, 1995 5 for 4
November 12, 1996 December 17, 1996 3 for 2
January 28, 1997 March 3, 1997 5 for 4
October 22, 1997 November 21, 1997 2 for 1
June 26, 2002 June 27, 2002 1 for 7
July 29, 2003 August 25, 2003 3 for 2
September 15, 2003 October 15, 2003 3 for 2



A-84


SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA (1)



(Amounts in thousands, except per share data)
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2003 2002 2001 2000 1999
----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ------------

Revenue (2) $ 1,800,374 $ 1,276,067 $ 1,263,700 $ 1,297,164 $ 1,193,347
Gross profit (2) 100,223 71,994 73,775 133,829 98,552
Operating income from continuing operations (2) 20,895 747 6,774 54,169 (44,681)
Income (loss) from continuing operations (2) 12,955 13,805 3,098 41,883 (70,530)
Total discontinued operations (2) (1,226) (15,478) (56,399) 1,800 (4,039)
Income (loss) before cumulative effect 11,729 (1,673) (53,301) 43,683 (74,443)
Net income (loss) $ 11,729 $ (42,421) $ (53,301) $ 43,683 $ (87,847)

Basic per share:
Income (loss) from continuing operations $ 0.71 $ 0.77 $ 0.17 $ 2.35 $ (4.12)
Discontinued operations (0.07) (0.86) (3.14) 0.10 (0.23)
Cumulative effect of accounting change,
net of tax -- (2.26) -- -- (0.78)
----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ------------
Net income (loss) $ 0.64 $ (2.35) $ (2.97) $ 2.45 $ (5.13)
=========== =========== =========== =========== ============

Diluted per share:
Income (loss) from continuing operations $ 0.68 $ 0.77 $ 0.17 $ 2.32 $ (4.12)
Discontinued operations (0.06) (0.86) (3.14) 0.10 (0.23)
Cumulative effect of accounting change,
net of tax -- (2.26) -- -- (0.78)
----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ------------
Net income (loss) $ 0.62 $ (2.35) $ (2.97) $ 2.42 $ (5.13)
=========== =========== =========== =========== ============




DECEMBER 31
------------------------------------------------------------
2003 2002 2001 2000 1999
-------- -------- -------- -------- --------

Working capital $ 89,345 $ 50,943 $160,015 $267,557 $261,037
Total assets 444,690 336,302 609,420 687,787 617,500
Long-term obligations -- -- 131,647 198,441 230,886
Total liabilities 297,106 222,659 459,407 493,690 468,723
Stockholders' equity 147,584 113,643 150,013 194,097 148,777


(1) Operating data includes certain items that were recorded in the years
presented as follows: restructuring and other unusual charges in 1999;
facility consolidation charges in 2003, 2001 and 2000;and the
cumulative effect of an accounting change in 2002 and 1999. See
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results
of Operations and Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

(2) We have reclassified certain prior year amounts to conform to the 2003
presentation. The amounts reclassified had no effect on net income or
earnings per share.


A-85


BRIGHTPOINT, INC.
INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES



PAGE

Consent of Independent Auditors.................................................................................. F-1
Financial Statement Schedule for the years 2003, 2002 and 2001:
SCHEDULE II - VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS.............................................................. F-2





CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS

We consent to the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statement (Form
S-8 No. 333-87863) pertaining to the Brightpoint, Inc. 1994 Stock Option Plan,
as amended, the 1996 Brightpoint, Inc. Stock Option Plan, as amended, the
Brightpoint, Inc. Non-employee Director Stock Option Plan, and the Brightpoint,
Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan, and in the Registration Statement (Form S-8
No. 333-108496) pertaining to the Brightpoint, Inc. Independent Director Stock
Compensation Plan, of our report dated January 23, 2004, except for Note 18, as
to which the date is February 19, 2004 with respect to the Consolidated
Financial Statements and Schedule of Brightpoint, Inc. included in the Annual
Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.



/s/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP
---------------------


Indianapolis, Indiana
March 5, 2004


F-1




BRIGHTPOINT, INC.
SCHEDULE II - VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
(Amounts in thousands)



COL. A COL. B COL. C COL. D COL. E
-------------- ---------------- ----------- ----------------- ---------------
BALANCE AT CHARGED TO CHARGED TO BALANCE AT
BEGINNING COSTS AND OTHER END
DESCRIPTION OF PERIOD EXPENSES ACCOUNTS DEDUCTIONS OF PERIOD
----------- -------------- ---------------- ----------- ----------------- ---------------

Year ended December 31, 2003:
Deducted from asset accounts:
Allowance for doubtful
accounts..................... $ 13,948 $ 3,861 $ -- $ (10,126) $ 7,683
Inventory valuation reserve..... $ 3,962 $ 4,663 $ -- $ (3,582) $ 5,043
-------------- ---------------- ----------- ----------------- ---------------
Total .......................... $ 17,910 $ 8,524 $ -- $ (13,708) $ 12,726
============== ================ =========== ================= ===============

Year ended December 31, 2002:
Deducted from asset accounts:
Allowance for doubtful
accounts..................... $ 15,669 $ 5,561 $ -- $ (7,282) $ 13,948
Inventory valuation reserve..... $ 9,894 $ 9,769 $ -- $ (15,701) $ 3,962
-------------- ---------------- ----------- ----------------- ---------------
Total .......................... $ 25,563 $ 15,330 $ -- $ (22,983) $ 17,910
============== ================ =========== ================= ===============

Year ended December 31, 2001:
Deducted from asset accounts:
Allowance for doubtful
accounts..................... $ 12,873 $ 8,359 $ -- $ (5,563) $ 15,669
Inventory valuation reserve..... $ 10,067 $ 6,347 $ -- $ (6,520) $ 9,894
-------------- ---------------- ----------- ----------------- ---------------
Total .......................... $ 22,940 $ 14,706 $ -- $ (12,083) $ 25,563
============== ================ =========== ================= ===============


Note: Amounts in table includes continuing and discontinuing operations.


F-2